LCOV - code coverage report
Current view: top level - src/backend/access/transam - xlog.c (source / functions) Coverage Total Hit
Test: PostgreSQL 19devel Lines: 88.7 % 2499 2216
Test Date: 2026-02-27 16:14:47 Functions: 97.6 % 124 121
Legend: Lines:     hit not hit

            Line data    Source code
       1              : /*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
       2              :  *
       3              :  * xlog.c
       4              :  *      PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
       5              :  *
       6              :  * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
       7              :  * files, in addition to this one:
       8              :  *
       9              :  * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
      10              :  * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
      11              :  * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
      12              :  * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
      13              :  *
      14              :  * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
      15              :  * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
      16              :  * system is running.
      17              :  *
      18              :  * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process.  It
      19              :  * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
      20              :  * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
      21              :  *
      22              :  * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers.  Most
      23              :  * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
      24              :  * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record.  XLogFlush() can be used
      25              :  * to force the WAL to disk.
      26              :  *
      27              :  * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
      28              :  * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
      29              :  *
      30              :  *
      31              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
      32              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
      33              :  *
      34              :  * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
      35              :  *
      36              :  *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
      37              :  */
      38              : 
      39              : #include "postgres.h"
      40              : 
      41              : #include <ctype.h>
      42              : #include <math.h>
      43              : #include <time.h>
      44              : #include <fcntl.h>
      45              : #include <sys/stat.h>
      46              : #include <sys/time.h>
      47              : #include <unistd.h>
      48              : 
      49              : #include "access/clog.h"
      50              : #include "access/commit_ts.h"
      51              : #include "access/heaptoast.h"
      52              : #include "access/multixact.h"
      53              : #include "access/rewriteheap.h"
      54              : #include "access/subtrans.h"
      55              : #include "access/timeline.h"
      56              : #include "access/transam.h"
      57              : #include "access/twophase.h"
      58              : #include "access/xact.h"
      59              : #include "access/xlog_internal.h"
      60              : #include "access/xlogarchive.h"
      61              : #include "access/xloginsert.h"
      62              : #include "access/xlogreader.h"
      63              : #include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
      64              : #include "access/xlogutils.h"
      65              : #include "access/xlogwait.h"
      66              : #include "backup/basebackup.h"
      67              : #include "catalog/catversion.h"
      68              : #include "catalog/pg_control.h"
      69              : #include "catalog/pg_database.h"
      70              : #include "common/controldata_utils.h"
      71              : #include "common/file_utils.h"
      72              : #include "executor/instrument.h"
      73              : #include "miscadmin.h"
      74              : #include "pg_trace.h"
      75              : #include "pgstat.h"
      76              : #include "port/atomics.h"
      77              : #include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
      78              : #include "postmaster/startup.h"
      79              : #include "postmaster/walsummarizer.h"
      80              : #include "postmaster/walwriter.h"
      81              : #include "replication/origin.h"
      82              : #include "replication/slot.h"
      83              : #include "replication/slotsync.h"
      84              : #include "replication/snapbuild.h"
      85              : #include "replication/walreceiver.h"
      86              : #include "replication/walsender.h"
      87              : #include "storage/bufmgr.h"
      88              : #include "storage/fd.h"
      89              : #include "storage/ipc.h"
      90              : #include "storage/large_object.h"
      91              : #include "storage/latch.h"
      92              : #include "storage/predicate.h"
      93              : #include "storage/proc.h"
      94              : #include "storage/procarray.h"
      95              : #include "storage/reinit.h"
      96              : #include "storage/spin.h"
      97              : #include "storage/sync.h"
      98              : #include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
      99              : #include "utils/guc_tables.h"
     100              : #include "utils/injection_point.h"
     101              : #include "utils/pgstat_internal.h"
     102              : #include "utils/ps_status.h"
     103              : #include "utils/relmapper.h"
     104              : #include "utils/snapmgr.h"
     105              : #include "utils/timeout.h"
     106              : #include "utils/timestamp.h"
     107              : #include "utils/varlena.h"
     108              : 
     109              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     110              : #include "utils/memutils.h"
     111              : #endif
     112              : 
     113              : /* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
     114              : #define BootstrapTimeLineID     1
     115              : 
     116              : /* User-settable parameters */
     117              : int         max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
     118              : int         min_wal_size_mb = 80;   /* 80 MB */
     119              : int         wal_keep_size_mb = 0;
     120              : int         XLOGbuffers = -1;
     121              : int         XLogArchiveTimeout = 0;
     122              : int         XLogArchiveMode = ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF;
     123              : char       *XLogArchiveCommand = NULL;
     124              : bool        EnableHotStandby = false;
     125              : bool        fullPageWrites = true;
     126              : bool        wal_log_hints = false;
     127              : int         wal_compression = WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE;
     128              : char       *wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL;
     129              : bool       *wal_consistency_checking = NULL;
     130              : bool        wal_init_zero = true;
     131              : bool        wal_recycle = true;
     132              : bool        log_checkpoints = true;
     133              : int         wal_sync_method = DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD;
     134              : int         wal_level = WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA;
     135              : int         CommitDelay = 0;    /* precommit delay in microseconds */
     136              : int         CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
     137              : int         wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000;
     138              : int         max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1;
     139              : int         wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
     140              : bool        track_wal_io_timing = false;
     141              : 
     142              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     143              : bool        XLOG_DEBUG = false;
     144              : #endif
     145              : 
     146              : int         wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE;
     147              : 
     148              : /*
     149              :  * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
     150              :  * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
     151              :  * which needs to iterate all the locks.
     152              :  */
     153              : #define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS  8
     154              : 
     155              : /*
     156              :  * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
     157              :  * checkpoint.
     158              :  */
     159              : int         CheckPointSegments;
     160              : 
     161              : /* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
     162              : static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0;
     163              : static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
     164              : 
     165              : /*
     166              :  * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
     167              :  * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
     168              :  */
     169              : static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false;
     170              : 
     171              : /*
     172              :  * GUC support
     173              :  */
     174              : const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[] = {
     175              :     {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
     176              : #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
     177              :     {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
     178              : #endif
     179              :     {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
     180              : #ifdef O_SYNC
     181              :     {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
     182              : #endif
     183              : #ifdef O_DSYNC
     184              :     {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
     185              : #endif
     186              :     {NULL, 0, false}
     187              : };
     188              : 
     189              : 
     190              : /*
     191              :  * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
     192              :  * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
     193              :  */
     194              : const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[] = {
     195              :     {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
     196              :     {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
     197              :     {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
     198              :     {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     199              :     {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     200              :     {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     201              :     {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     202              :     {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     203              :     {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     204              :     {NULL, 0, false}
     205              : };
     206              : 
     207              : /*
     208              :  * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
     209              :  * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
     210              :  * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
     211              :  */
     212              : CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats;
     213              : 
     214              : /*
     215              :  * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
     216              :  * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
     217              :  * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
     218              :  * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
     219              :  */
     220              : static bool lastFullPageWrites;
     221              : 
     222              : /*
     223              :  * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
     224              :  * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.  True actually
     225              :  * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
     226              :  */
     227              : static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
     228              : 
     229              : /*
     230              :  * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
     231              :  *      1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
     232              :  *      0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
     233              :  *      -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
     234              :  * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
     235              :  * is not in progress.  But we can also force the value for special cases.
     236              :  * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
     237              :  * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
     238              :  */
     239              : static int  LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1;
     240              : 
     241              : /*
     242              :  * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
     243              :  * current backend.  It is updated for all inserts.  XactLastRecEnd points to
     244              :  * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
     245              :  * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
     246              :  * created any XLOG records.
     247              :  *
     248              :  * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date.  When committing,
     249              :  * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
     250              :  * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
     251              :  * the transaction.  But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
     252              :  * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
     253              :  * stored here.  The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
     254              :  * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
     255              :  */
     256              : XLogRecPtr  ProcLastRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     257              : XLogRecPtr  XactLastRecEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     258              : XLogRecPtr  XactLastCommitEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     259              : 
     260              : /*
     261              :  * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
     262              :  * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
     263              :  * CHECKPOINT record).  We update this from the shared-memory copy,
     264              :  * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
     265              :  * hold an insertion lock).  See XLogInsertRecord for details.  We are also
     266              :  * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
     267              :  * see GetRedoRecPtr.
     268              :  *
     269              :  * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
     270              :  * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
     271              :  * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
     272              :  * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
     273              :  * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
     274              :  * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
     275              :  */
     276              : static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr;
     277              : 
     278              : /*
     279              :  * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
     280              :  * runningBackups > 0).  It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
     281              :  * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
     282              :  *
     283              :  * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
     284              :  * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
     285              :  * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
     286              :  * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
     287              :  * accurate.
     288              :  */
     289              : static bool doPageWrites;
     290              : 
     291              : /*----------
     292              :  * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
     293              :  *
     294              :  * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
     295              :  * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
     296              :  * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
     297              :  * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
     298              :  * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
     299              :  * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
     300              :  *
     301              :  * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
     302              :  * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
     303              :  *
     304              :  * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
     305              :  * so it's a plain spinlock.  The other locks are held longer (potentially
     306              :  * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them.  These locks are:
     307              :  *
     308              :  * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
     309              :  * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping.  If the
     310              :  * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
     311              :  * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
     312              :  *
     313              :  * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
     314              :  * XLogFlush).
     315              :  *
     316              :  * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
     317              :  * new log file.
     318              :  *
     319              :  *----------
     320              :  */
     321              : 
     322              : typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
     323              : {
     324              :     XLogRecPtr  Write;          /* last byte + 1 to write out */
     325              :     XLogRecPtr  Flush;          /* last byte + 1 to flush */
     326              : } XLogwrtRqst;
     327              : 
     328              : typedef struct XLogwrtResult
     329              : {
     330              :     XLogRecPtr  Write;          /* last byte + 1 written out */
     331              :     XLogRecPtr  Flush;          /* last byte + 1 flushed */
     332              : } XLogwrtResult;
     333              : 
     334              : /*
     335              :  * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
     336              :  * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
     337              :  * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
     338              :  * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
     339              :  * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
     340              :  *
     341              :  * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
     342              :  * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
     343              :  * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
     344              :  * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
     345              :  * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
     346              :  * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
     347              :  * you're about to write out.
     348              :  *
     349              :  * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
     350              :  * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
     351              :  * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
     352              :  * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
     353              :  * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
     354              :  * insertion.
     355              :  *
     356              :  * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
     357              :  * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
     358              :  * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
     359              :  * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
     360              :  *
     361              :  * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
     362              :  * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
     363              :  * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
     364              :  * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
     365              :  * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
     366              :  * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
     367              :  * records.  Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
     368              :  * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
     369              :  */
     370              : typedef struct
     371              : {
     372              :     LWLock      lock;
     373              :     pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt;
     374              :     XLogRecPtr  lastImportantAt;
     375              : } WALInsertLock;
     376              : 
     377              : /*
     378              :  * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
     379              :  * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
     380              :  * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
     381              :  * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
     382              :  * array start address is suitably aligned.)
     383              :  */
     384              : typedef union WALInsertLockPadded
     385              : {
     386              :     WALInsertLock l;
     387              :     char        pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
     388              : } WALInsertLockPadded;
     389              : 
     390              : /*
     391              :  * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
     392              :  * functions to start and stop backups.
     393              :  */
     394              : static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
     395              : 
     396              : /*
     397              :  * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
     398              :  */
     399              : typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
     400              : {
     401              :     slock_t     insertpos_lck;  /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
     402              : 
     403              :     /*
     404              :      * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
     405              :      * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
     406              :      * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
     407              :      * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
     408              :      * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
     409              :      */
     410              :     uint64      CurrBytePos;
     411              :     uint64      PrevBytePos;
     412              : 
     413              :     /*
     414              :      * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
     415              :      * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
     416              :      * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
     417              :      * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
     418              :      * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
     419              :      */
     420              :     char        pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
     421              : 
     422              :     /*
     423              :      * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
     424              :      * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
     425              :      * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
     426              :      * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
     427              :      * actually affects WAL-logging by backends.  Checkpointer sets at startup
     428              :      * or after SIGHUP.
     429              :      *
     430              :      * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
     431              :      * you must hold ALL the locks.
     432              :      */
     433              :     XLogRecPtr  RedoRecPtr;     /* current redo point for insertions */
     434              :     bool        fullPageWrites;
     435              : 
     436              :     /*
     437              :      * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
     438              :      * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
     439              :      * used as a starting point for an online backup.
     440              :      */
     441              :     int         runningBackups;
     442              :     XLogRecPtr  lastBackupStart;
     443              : 
     444              :     /*
     445              :      * WAL insertion locks.
     446              :      */
     447              :     WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks;
     448              : } XLogCtlInsert;
     449              : 
     450              : /*
     451              :  * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
     452              :  */
     453              : typedef struct XLogCtlData
     454              : {
     455              :     XLogCtlInsert Insert;
     456              : 
     457              :     /* Protected by info_lck: */
     458              :     XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst;
     459              :     XLogRecPtr  RedoRecPtr;     /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
     460              :     XLogRecPtr  asyncXactLSN;   /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
     461              :     XLogRecPtr  replicationSlotMinLSN;  /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
     462              : 
     463              :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;   /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
     464              : 
     465              :     /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
     466              :     pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN;
     467              : 
     468              :     /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
     469              :     pg_time_t   lastSegSwitchTime;
     470              :     XLogRecPtr  lastSegSwitchLSN;
     471              : 
     472              :     /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
     473              :     pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult;   /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
     474              :     pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult;    /* last byte + 1 written out */
     475              :     pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult;    /* last byte + 1 flushed */
     476              : 
     477              :     /*
     478              :      * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
     479              :      *
     480              :      * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
     481              :      * hold WALBufMappingLock.  To change the identity of a buffer that's
     482              :      * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
     483              :      * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
     484              :      * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
     485              :      * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
     486              :      */
     487              :     XLogRecPtr  InitializedUpTo;
     488              : 
     489              :     /*
     490              :      * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
     491              :      * and xlblocks values certainly do.  xlblocks values are protected by
     492              :      * WALBufMappingLock.
     493              :      */
     494              :     char       *pages;          /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
     495              :     pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
     496              :     int         XLogCacheBlck;  /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
     497              : 
     498              :     /*
     499              :      * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
     500              :      * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
     501              :      *
     502              :      * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
     503              :      * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
     504              :      * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
     505              :      *
     506              :      * We set these fields while holding info_lck. Most that reads these
     507              :      * values knows that recovery is no longer in progress and so can safely
     508              :      * read the value without a lock, but code that could be run either during
     509              :      * or after recovery can take info_lck while reading these values.
     510              :      */
     511              :     TimeLineID  InsertTimeLineID;
     512              :     TimeLineID  PrevTimeLineID;
     513              : 
     514              :     /*
     515              :      * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
     516              :      * recovery.  Protected by info_lck.
     517              :      */
     518              :     RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState;
     519              : 
     520              :     /*
     521              :      * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
     522              :      * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
     523              :      * Protected by ControlFileLock.  Only the startup process changes it.  If
     524              :      * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment().  If false, the startup
     525              :      * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
     526              :      * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
     527              :      */
     528              :     bool        InstallXLogFileSegmentActive;
     529              : 
     530              :     /*
     531              :      * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
     532              :      * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
     533              :      * Protected by info_lck.
     534              :      */
     535              :     bool        WalWriterSleeping;
     536              : 
     537              :     /*
     538              :      * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
     539              :      * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
     540              :      * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record.  Used by the
     541              :      * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
     542              :      *
     543              :      * Protected by info_lck.
     544              :      */
     545              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointRecPtr;
     546              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointEndPtr;
     547              :     CheckPoint  lastCheckPoint;
     548              : 
     549              :     /*
     550              :      * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
     551              :      * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
     552              :      */
     553              :     XLogRecPtr  lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
     554              : 
     555              :     slock_t     info_lck;       /* locks shared variables shown above */
     556              : } XLogCtlData;
     557              : 
     558              : /*
     559              :  * Classification of XLogInsertRecord operations.
     560              :  */
     561              : typedef enum
     562              : {
     563              :     WALINSERT_NORMAL,
     564              :     WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH,
     565              :     WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
     566              : } WalInsertClass;
     567              : 
     568              : static XLogCtlData *XLogCtl = NULL;
     569              : 
     570              : /* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
     571              : static WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks = NULL;
     572              : 
     573              : /*
     574              :  * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
     575              :  */
     576              : static ControlFileData *ControlFile = NULL;
     577              : 
     578              : /*
     579              :  * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
     580              :  * multiple evaluation!
     581              :  */
     582              : #define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)    \
     583              :     (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
     584              : 
     585              : /* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
     586              : #define NextBufIdx(idx)     \
     587              :         (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
     588              : 
     589              : /*
     590              :  * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
     591              :  * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
     592              :  */
     593              : #define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)  \
     594              :     (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
     595              : 
     596              : /*
     597              :  * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
     598              :  */
     599              : #define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
     600              : 
     601              : /*
     602              :  * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
     603              :  * Rounds down.
     604              :  */
     605              : #define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)  XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
     606              : 
     607              : /* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
     608              : static int  UsableBytesInSegment;
     609              : 
     610              : /*
     611              :  * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
     612              :  * See discussion above.
     613              :  */
     614              : static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult = {0, 0};
     615              : 
     616              : /*
     617              :  * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
     618              :  *
     619              :  * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
     620              :  * important, as is the barrier.  See also XLogWrite.
     621              :  */
     622              : #define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
     623              :     do { \
     624              :         _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
     625              :         pg_read_barrier(); \
     626              :         _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
     627              :     } while (0)
     628              : 
     629              : /*
     630              :  * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
     631              :  * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
     632              :  * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
     633              :  * to the active segment.
     634              :  *
     635              :  * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
     636              :  */
     637              : static int  openLogFile = -1;
     638              : static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0;
     639              : static TimeLineID openLogTLI = 0;
     640              : 
     641              : /*
     642              :  * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file.  When running
     643              :  * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
     644              :  * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
     645              :  * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
     646              :  * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
     647              :  */
     648              : static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint;
     649              : static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI;
     650              : static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
     651              : 
     652              : /* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
     653              : static int  MyLockNo = 0;
     654              : static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
     655              : 
     656              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     657              : static MemoryContext walDebugCxt = NULL;
     658              : #endif
     659              : 
     660              : static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI,
     661              :                                         XLogRecPtr EndOfLog,
     662              :                                         TimeLineID newTLI);
     663              : static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
     664              : static void XLogReportParameters(void);
     665              : static int  LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
     666              : static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
     667              : static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn,
     668              :                                                   XLogRecPtr pagePtr,
     669              :                                                   TimeLineID newTLI);
     670              : static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
     671              : static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo);
     672              : 
     673              : static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli,
     674              :                                   bool opportunistic);
     675              : static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
     676              : static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
     677              :                                    bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno,
     678              :                                    TimeLineID tli);
     679              : static void XLogFileClose(void);
     680              : static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
     681              : static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
     682              : static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr,
     683              :                                XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI);
     684              : static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
     685              :                            XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo,
     686              :                            TimeLineID insertTLI);
     687              : static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
     688              : static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
     689              : static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
     690              : static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
     691              : static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
     692              : static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version);
     693              : static void WriteControlFile(void);
     694              : static void ReadControlFile(void);
     695              : static void UpdateControlFile(void);
     696              : static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize);
     697              : 
     698              : static int  get_sync_bit(int method);
     699              : 
     700              : static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
     701              :                                 XLogRecData *rdata,
     702              :                                 XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos,
     703              :                                 TimeLineID tli);
     704              : static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
     705              :                                       XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
     706              : static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
     707              :                               XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
     708              : static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto);
     709              : static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
     710              : static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
     711              : static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
     712              : static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr);
     713              : 
     714              : static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
     715              : static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
     716              : static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
     717              : static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
     718              : 
     719              : /*
     720              :  * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
     721              :  * chunks.  This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
     722              :  * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
     723              :  *
     724              :  * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
     725              :  * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
     726              :  * images.  If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
     727              :  * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr.  The caller can then recalculate
     728              :  * which pages need a full-page image, and retry.  If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
     729              :  * record is always inserted.
     730              :  *
     731              :  * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
     732              :  * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
     733              :  *
     734              :  * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
     735              :  * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
     736              :  *
     737              :  * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
     738              :  * data must be MAXALIGNed.  XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
     739              :  * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
     740              :  * by the caller.
     741              :  *
     742              :  * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
     743              :  * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
     744              :  * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
     745              :  * before the data page can be written out.  This implements the basic
     746              :  * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
     747              :  */
     748              : XLogRecPtr
     749     15401039 : XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata,
     750              :                  XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn,
     751              :                  uint8 flags,
     752              :                  int num_fpi,
     753              :                  uint64 fpi_bytes,
     754              :                  bool topxid_included)
     755              : {
     756     15401039 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
     757              :     pg_crc32c   rdata_crc;
     758              :     bool        inserted;
     759     15401039 :     XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
     760     15401039 :     uint8       info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
     761     15401039 :     WalInsertClass class = WALINSERT_NORMAL;
     762              :     XLogRecPtr  StartPos;
     763              :     XLogRecPtr  EndPos;
     764     15401039 :     bool        prevDoPageWrites = doPageWrites;
     765              :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
     766              : 
     767              :     /* Does this record type require special handling? */
     768     15401039 :     if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
     769              :     {
     770       234223 :         if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
     771          801 :             class = WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH;
     772       233422 :         else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
     773          931 :             class = WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT;
     774              :     }
     775              : 
     776              :     /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
     777              :     Assert(rdata->len >= SizeOfXLogRecord);
     778              : 
     779              :     /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
     780     15401039 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
     781            0 :         elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
     782              : 
     783              :     /*
     784              :      * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
     785              :      * change, so we can read it without a lock.
     786              :      */
     787     15401039 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
     788              : 
     789              :     /*----------
     790              :      *
     791              :      * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
     792              :      * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
     793              :      * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
     794              :      *
     795              :      * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
     796              :      *    reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
     797              :      *    insertpos_lck.
     798              :      *
     799              :      * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
     800              :      *    correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
     801              :      *    record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
     802              :      *
     803              :      * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
     804              :      * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
     805              :      * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
     806              :      * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
     807              :      * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
     808              :      * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
     809              :      * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
     810              :      *
     811              :      * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
     812              :      * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
     813              :      *
     814              :      * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
     815              :      * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
     816              :      * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
     817              :      * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
     818              :      *
     819              :      *----------
     820              :      */
     821     15401039 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
     822              : 
     823     15401039 :     if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
     824              :     {
     825     15399307 :         WALInsertLockAcquire();
     826              : 
     827              :         /*
     828              :          * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
     829              :          * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
     830              :          * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
     831              :          * this case and fast otherwise.
     832              :          *
     833              :          * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
     834              :          * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
     835              :          * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
     836              :          *
     837              :          * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
     838              :          * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
     839              :          * our local copy but not force a recomputation.  (If doPageWrites was
     840              :          * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
     841              :          * but we choose not to bother.)
     842              :          */
     843     15399307 :         if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
     844              :         {
     845              :             Assert(RedoRecPtr < Insert->RedoRecPtr);
     846         7351 :             RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
     847              :         }
     848     15399307 :         doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
     849              : 
     850     15399307 :         if (doPageWrites &&
     851     15150545 :             (!prevDoPageWrites ||
     852     13904957 :              (XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn) && fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr)))
     853              :         {
     854              :             /*
     855              :              * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
     856              :              * didn't back up.  Start over.
     857              :              */
     858         8030 :             WALInsertLockRelease();
     859         8030 :             END_CRIT_SECTION();
     860         8030 :             return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     861              :         }
     862              : 
     863              :         /*
     864              :          * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
     865              :          * pointer.
     866              :          */
     867     15391277 :         ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
     868              :                                   &rechdr->xl_prev);
     869              : 
     870              :         /* Normal records are always inserted. */
     871     15391277 :         inserted = true;
     872              :     }
     873         1732 :     else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
     874              :     {
     875              :         /*
     876              :          * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
     877              :          * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
     878              :          * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
     879              :          * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
     880              :          *
     881              :          * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
     882              :          * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
     883              :          * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
     884              :          * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
     885              :          */
     886              :         Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn));
     887          801 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
     888          801 :         inserted = ReserveXLogSwitch(&StartPos, &EndPos, &rechdr->xl_prev);
     889              :     }
     890              :     else
     891              :     {
     892              :         Assert(class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT);
     893              : 
     894              :         /*
     895              :          * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
     896              :          * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
     897              :          * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
     898              :          * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
     899              :          * update it afterwards.
     900              :          */
     901              :         Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn));
     902          931 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
     903          931 :         ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
     904              :                                   &rechdr->xl_prev);
     905          931 :         RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
     906          931 :         inserted = true;
     907              :     }
     908              : 
     909     15393009 :     if (inserted)
     910              :     {
     911              :         /*
     912              :          * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
     913              :          * header.
     914              :          */
     915     15392949 :         rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
     916     15392949 :         COMP_CRC32C(rdata_crc, rechdr, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
     917     15392949 :         FIN_CRC32C(rdata_crc);
     918     15392949 :         rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
     919              : 
     920              :         /*
     921              :          * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
     922              :          * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
     923              :          */
     924     15392949 :         CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
     925              :                             class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH, rdata,
     926              :                             StartPos, EndPos, insertTLI);
     927              : 
     928              :         /*
     929              :          * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
     930              :          * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
     931              :          * update the first one.
     932              :          */
     933     15392949 :         if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
     934              :         {
     935     15271589 :             int         lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
     936              : 
     937     15271589 :             WALInsertLocks[lockno].l.lastImportantAt = StartPos;
     938              :         }
     939              :     }
     940              :     else
     941              :     {
     942              :         /*
     943              :          * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
     944              :          * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
     945              :          * to do anything.
     946              :          */
     947              :     }
     948              : 
     949              :     /*
     950              :      * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
     951              :      */
     952     15393009 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
     953              : 
     954     15393009 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
     955              : 
     956     15393009 :     MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny();
     957              : 
     958              :     /*
     959              :      * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
     960              :      * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
     961              :      */
     962     15393009 :     if (topxid_included)
     963          219 :         MarkSubxactTopXidLogged();
     964              : 
     965              :     /*
     966              :      * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
     967              :      */
     968     15393009 :     if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     969              :     {
     970      1702919 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
     971              :         /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
     972      1702919 :         if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < EndPos)
     973      1632887 :             XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndPos;
     974      1702919 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
     975      1702919 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
     976              :     }
     977              : 
     978              :     /*
     979              :      * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
     980              :      * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
     981              :      * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
     982              :      */
     983     15393009 :     if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
     984              :     {
     985              :         TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_SWITCH();
     986          801 :         XLogFlush(EndPos);
     987              : 
     988              :         /*
     989              :          * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
     990              :          * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
     991              :          * xlog-switch record.
     992              :          */
     993          801 :         if (inserted)
     994              :         {
     995          741 :             EndPos = StartPos + SizeOfXLogRecord;
     996          741 :             if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     997              :             {
     998            0 :                 uint64      offset = XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size);
     999              : 
    1000            0 :                 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1001            0 :                     EndPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1002              :                 else
    1003            0 :                     EndPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1004              :             }
    1005              :         }
    1006              :     }
    1007              : 
    1008              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    1009              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    1010              :     {
    1011              :         static XLogReaderState *debug_reader = NULL;
    1012              :         XLogRecord *record;
    1013              :         DecodedXLogRecord *decoded;
    1014              :         StringInfoData buf;
    1015              :         StringInfoData recordBuf;
    1016              :         char       *errormsg = NULL;
    1017              :         MemoryContext oldCxt;
    1018              : 
    1019              :         oldCxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(walDebugCxt);
    1020              : 
    1021              :         initStringInfo(&buf);
    1022              :         appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
    1023              : 
    1024              :         /*
    1025              :          * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
    1026              :          * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
    1027              :          * contiguous chunk.
    1028              :          */
    1029              :         initStringInfo(&recordBuf);
    1030              :         for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
    1031              :             appendBinaryStringInfo(&recordBuf, rdata->data, rdata->len);
    1032              : 
    1033              :         /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
    1034              :         record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
    1035              :         decoded = (DecodedXLogRecord *)
    1036              :             palloc(DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(record->xl_tot_len));
    1037              : 
    1038              :         if (!debug_reader)
    1039              :             debug_reader = XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL,
    1040              :                                               XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
    1041              :                                                          .segment_open = NULL,
    1042              :                                                          .segment_close = NULL),
    1043              :                                               NULL);
    1044              :         if (!debug_reader)
    1045              :         {
    1046              :             appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
    1047              :         }
    1048              :         else if (!DecodeXLogRecord(debug_reader,
    1049              :                                    decoded,
    1050              :                                    record,
    1051              :                                    EndPos,
    1052              :                                    &errormsg))
    1053              :         {
    1054              :             appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
    1055              :                              errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
    1056              :         }
    1057              :         else
    1058              :         {
    1059              :             appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
    1060              : 
    1061              :             debug_reader->record = decoded;
    1062              :             xlog_outdesc(&buf, debug_reader);
    1063              :             debug_reader->record = NULL;
    1064              :         }
    1065              :         elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
    1066              : 
    1067              :         pfree(decoded);
    1068              :         pfree(buf.data);
    1069              :         pfree(recordBuf.data);
    1070              :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldCxt);
    1071              :     }
    1072              : #endif
    1073              : 
    1074              :     /*
    1075              :      * Update our global variables
    1076              :      */
    1077     15393009 :     ProcLastRecPtr = StartPos;
    1078     15393009 :     XactLastRecEnd = EndPos;
    1079              : 
    1080              :     /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
    1081     15393009 :     if (inserted)
    1082              :     {
    1083     15392949 :         pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
    1084     15392949 :         pgWalUsage.wal_records++;
    1085     15392949 :         pgWalUsage.wal_fpi += num_fpi;
    1086     15392949 :         pgWalUsage.wal_fpi_bytes += fpi_bytes;
    1087              : 
    1088              :         /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
    1089     15392949 :         pgstat_report_fixed = true;
    1090              :     }
    1091              : 
    1092     15393009 :     return EndPos;
    1093              : }
    1094              : 
    1095              : /*
    1096              :  * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
    1097              :  * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
    1098              :  * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
    1099              :  * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
    1100              :  *
    1101              :  * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
    1102              :  * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
    1103              :  * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
    1104              :  * busy system.
    1105              :  *
    1106              :  * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
    1107              :  * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
    1108              :  *
    1109              :  * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
    1110              :  * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
    1111              :  * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
    1112              :  */
    1113              : static pg_attribute_always_inline void
    1114     15392208 : ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
    1115              :                           XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
    1116              : {
    1117     15392208 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1118              :     uint64      startbytepos;
    1119              :     uint64      endbytepos;
    1120              :     uint64      prevbytepos;
    1121              : 
    1122     15392208 :     size = MAXALIGN(size);
    1123              : 
    1124              :     /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
    1125              :     Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1126              : 
    1127              :     /*
    1128              :      * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
    1129              :      * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
    1130              :      * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
    1131              :      * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
    1132              :      * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
    1133              :      * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
    1134              :      * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
    1135              :      * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
    1136              :      */
    1137     15392208 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1138              : 
    1139     15392208 :     startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1140     15392208 :     endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
    1141     15392208 :     prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
    1142     15392208 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
    1143     15392208 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
    1144              : 
    1145     15392208 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1146              : 
    1147     15392208 :     *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1148     15392208 :     *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
    1149     15392208 :     *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
    1150              : 
    1151              :     /*
    1152              :      * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
    1153              :      * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
    1154              :      */
    1155              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
    1156              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
    1157              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
    1158     15392208 : }
    1159              : 
    1160              : /*
    1161              :  * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
    1162              :  *
    1163              :  * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
    1164              :  * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
    1165              :  * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
    1166              :  * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
    1167              :  * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
    1168              : */
    1169              : static bool
    1170          801 : ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
    1171              : {
    1172          801 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1173              :     uint64      startbytepos;
    1174              :     uint64      endbytepos;
    1175              :     uint64      prevbytepos;
    1176          801 :     uint32      size = MAXALIGN(SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1177              :     XLogRecPtr  ptr;
    1178              :     uint32      segleft;
    1179              : 
    1180              :     /*
    1181              :      * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
    1182              :      * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
    1183              :      * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
    1184              :      * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
    1185              :      */
    1186          801 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1187              : 
    1188          801 :     startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1189              : 
    1190          801 :     ptr = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1191          801 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    1192              :     {
    1193           60 :         SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1194           60 :         *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
    1195           60 :         return false;
    1196              :     }
    1197              : 
    1198          741 :     endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
    1199          741 :     prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
    1200              : 
    1201          741 :     *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1202          741 :     *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
    1203              : 
    1204          741 :     segleft = wal_segment_size - XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size);
    1205          741 :     if (segleft != wal_segment_size)
    1206              :     {
    1207              :         /* consume the rest of the segment */
    1208          741 :         *EndPos += segleft;
    1209          741 :         endbytepos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos);
    1210              :     }
    1211          741 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
    1212          741 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
    1213              : 
    1214          741 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1215              : 
    1216          741 :     *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
    1217              : 
    1218              :     Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
    1219              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
    1220              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
    1221              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
    1222              : 
    1223          741 :     return true;
    1224              : }
    1225              : 
    1226              : /*
    1227              :  * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord.  Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
    1228              :  * area in the WAL.
    1229              :  */
    1230              : static void
    1231     15392949 : CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata,
    1232              :                     XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
    1233              : {
    1234              :     char       *currpos;
    1235              :     int         freespace;
    1236              :     int         written;
    1237              :     XLogRecPtr  CurrPos;
    1238              :     XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
    1239              : 
    1240              :     /*
    1241              :      * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
    1242              :      * inserting to.
    1243              :      */
    1244     15392949 :     CurrPos = StartPos;
    1245     15392949 :     currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1246     15392949 :     freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
    1247              : 
    1248              :     /*
    1249              :      * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
    1250              :      * on this page.
    1251              :      */
    1252              :     Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
    1253              : 
    1254              :     /* Copy record data */
    1255     15392949 :     written = 0;
    1256     72621328 :     while (rdata != NULL)
    1257              :     {
    1258     57228379 :         const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
    1259     57228379 :         int         rdata_len = rdata->len;
    1260              : 
    1261     59043673 :         while (rdata_len > freespace)
    1262              :         {
    1263              :             /*
    1264              :              * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
    1265              :              */
    1266              :             Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
    1267      1815294 :             memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
    1268      1815294 :             rdata_data += freespace;
    1269      1815294 :             rdata_len -= freespace;
    1270      1815294 :             written += freespace;
    1271      1815294 :             CurrPos += freespace;
    1272              : 
    1273              :             /*
    1274              :              * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
    1275              :              * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
    1276              :              *
    1277              :              * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
    1278              :              * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
    1279              :              * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
    1280              :              * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
    1281              :              */
    1282      1815294 :             currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1283      1815294 :             pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
    1284      1815294 :             pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
    1285      1815294 :             pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
    1286              : 
    1287              :             /* skip over the page header */
    1288      1815294 :             if (XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    1289              :             {
    1290         1181 :                 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1291         1181 :                 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1292              :             }
    1293              :             else
    1294              :             {
    1295      1814113 :                 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1296      1814113 :                 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1297              :             }
    1298      1815294 :             freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
    1299              :         }
    1300              : 
    1301              :         Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
    1302     57228379 :         memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
    1303     57228379 :         currpos += rdata_len;
    1304     57228379 :         CurrPos += rdata_len;
    1305     57228379 :         freespace -= rdata_len;
    1306     57228379 :         written += rdata_len;
    1307              : 
    1308     57228379 :         rdata = rdata->next;
    1309              :     }
    1310              :     Assert(written == write_len);
    1311              : 
    1312              :     /*
    1313              :      * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
    1314              :      * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment.  We
    1315              :      * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
    1316              :      */
    1317     15392949 :     if (isLogSwitch && XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) != 0)
    1318              :     {
    1319              :         /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
    1320              :         Assert(write_len == SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1321              : 
    1322              :         /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
    1323              :         Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
    1324              : 
    1325              :         /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
    1326          741 :         CurrPos += freespace;
    1327              : 
    1328              :         /*
    1329              :          * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
    1330              :          * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
    1331              :          * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
    1332              :          * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
    1333              :          */
    1334       730413 :         while (CurrPos < EndPos)
    1335              :         {
    1336              :             /*
    1337              :              * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
    1338              :              * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
    1339              :              * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...).  The page would be left initialized
    1340              :              * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
    1341              :              * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
    1342              :              *
    1343              :              * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
    1344              :              * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
    1345              :              * differ from page to page) are not.  The effect varies with
    1346              :              * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
    1347              :              * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
    1348              :              *
    1349              :              * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
    1350              :              * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
    1351              :              * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
    1352              :              * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
    1353              :              * and zero most of the page.  Then we just zero the page header.
    1354              :              */
    1355       729672 :             currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1356      2918688 :             MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    1357              : 
    1358       729672 :             CurrPos += XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1359              :         }
    1360              :     }
    1361              :     else
    1362              :     {
    1363              :         /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
    1364     15392208 :         CurrPos = MAXALIGN64(CurrPos);
    1365              :     }
    1366              : 
    1367     15392949 :     if (CurrPos != EndPos)
    1368            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    1369              :                 errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    1370              :                 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
    1371     15392949 : }
    1372              : 
    1373              : /*
    1374              :  * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
    1375              :  */
    1376              : static void
    1377     15399318 : WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
    1378              : {
    1379              :     bool        immed;
    1380              : 
    1381              :     /*
    1382              :      * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
    1383              :      * the one we used last time.  If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
    1384              :      * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
    1385              :      * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
    1386              :      * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
    1387              :      *
    1388              :      * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
    1389              :      * (semi-)randomly.  This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
    1390              :      * lot of very short connections.
    1391              :      */
    1392              :     static int  lockToTry = -1;
    1393              : 
    1394     15399318 :     if (lockToTry == -1)
    1395         8472 :         lockToTry = MyProcNumber % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    1396     15399318 :     MyLockNo = lockToTry;
    1397              : 
    1398              :     /*
    1399              :      * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
    1400              :      * insert location yet.
    1401              :      */
    1402     15399318 :     immed = LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1403     15399318 :     if (!immed)
    1404              :     {
    1405              :         /*
    1406              :          * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
    1407              :          * time.  On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
    1408              :          * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
    1409              :          * lock that no-one else is using.  On a system with more inserters
    1410              :          * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
    1411              :          * across the locks.
    1412              :          */
    1413        16550 :         lockToTry = (lockToTry + 1) % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    1414              :     }
    1415     15399318 : }
    1416              : 
    1417              : /*
    1418              :  * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
    1419              :  * to WAL.
    1420              :  */
    1421              : static void
    1422         4538 : WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
    1423              : {
    1424              :     int         i;
    1425              : 
    1426              :     /*
    1427              :      * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
    1428              :      * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
    1429              :      * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
    1430              :      */
    1431        36304 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
    1432              :     {
    1433        31766 :         LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1434        31766 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1435        31766 :                         &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1436              :                         PG_UINT64_MAX);
    1437              :     }
    1438              :     /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
    1439         4538 :     LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1440              : 
    1441         4538 :     holdingAllLocks = true;
    1442         4538 : }
    1443              : 
    1444              : /*
    1445              :  * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
    1446              :  *
    1447              :  * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
    1448              :  * next time the lock is acquired.
    1449              :  */
    1450              : static void
    1451     15403856 : WALInsertLockRelease(void)
    1452              : {
    1453     15403856 :     if (holdingAllLocks)
    1454              :     {
    1455              :         int         i;
    1456              : 
    1457        40842 :         for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    1458        36304 :             LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1459        36304 :                                   &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1460              :                                   0);
    1461              : 
    1462         4538 :         holdingAllLocks = false;
    1463              :     }
    1464              :     else
    1465              :     {
    1466     15399318 :         LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
    1467     15399318 :                               &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
    1468              :                               0);
    1469              :     }
    1470     15403856 : }
    1471              : 
    1472              : /*
    1473              :  * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
    1474              :  * inserting up to that point.
    1475              :  */
    1476              : static void
    1477      2509602 : WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
    1478              : {
    1479      2509602 :     if (holdingAllLocks)
    1480              :     {
    1481              :         /*
    1482              :          * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
    1483              :          * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
    1484              :          */
    1485       722958 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.lock,
    1486       722958 :                         &WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.insertingAt,
    1487              :                         insertingAt);
    1488              :     }
    1489              :     else
    1490      1786644 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
    1491      1786644 :                         &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
    1492              :                         insertingAt);
    1493      2509602 : }
    1494              : 
    1495              : /*
    1496              :  * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
    1497              :  *
    1498              :  * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
    1499              :  * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
    1500              :  * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
    1501              :  * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
    1502              :  *
    1503              :  * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
    1504              :  * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
    1505              :  * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
    1506              :  * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
    1507              :  * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
    1508              :  */
    1509              : static XLogRecPtr
    1510      2361668 : WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
    1511              : {
    1512              :     uint64      bytepos;
    1513              :     XLogRecPtr  inserted;
    1514              :     XLogRecPtr  reservedUpto;
    1515              :     XLogRecPtr  finishedUpto;
    1516      2361668 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1517              :     int         i;
    1518              : 
    1519      2361668 :     if (MyProc == NULL)
    1520            0 :         elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
    1521              : 
    1522              :     /*
    1523              :      * Check if there's any work to do.  Use a barrier to ensure we get the
    1524              :      * freshest value.
    1525              :      */
    1526      2361668 :     inserted = pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    1527      2361668 :     if (upto <= inserted)
    1528      1878959 :         return inserted;
    1529              : 
    1530              :     /* Read the current insert position */
    1531       482709 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1532       482709 :     bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1533       482709 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1534       482709 :     reservedUpto = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(bytepos);
    1535              : 
    1536              :     /*
    1537              :      * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
    1538              :      * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
    1539              :      * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
    1540              :      * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
    1541              :      * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
    1542              :      * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
    1543              :      */
    1544       482709 :     if (upto > reservedUpto)
    1545              :     {
    1546            0 :         ereport(LOG,
    1547              :                 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
    1548              :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(upto), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(reservedUpto)));
    1549            0 :         upto = reservedUpto;
    1550              :     }
    1551              : 
    1552              :     /*
    1553              :      * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
    1554              :      * than 'upto'.
    1555              :      *
    1556              :      * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
    1557              :      * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
    1558              :      * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
    1559              :      * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
    1560              :      */
    1561       482709 :     finishedUpto = reservedUpto;
    1562      4344381 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    1563              :     {
    1564      3861672 :         XLogRecPtr  insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1565              : 
    1566              :         do
    1567              :         {
    1568              :             /*
    1569              :              * See if this insertion is in progress.  LWLockWaitForVar will
    1570              :              * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
    1571              :              * by a LWLockUpdateVar call.  When a lock is initially acquired,
    1572              :              * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
    1573              :              * know where it's inserting yet.  We will have to wait for it. If
    1574              :              * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
    1575              :              * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
    1576              :              * calling LWLockUpdateVar.  But if it has to sleep, it will
    1577              :              * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
    1578              :              * sleeping.
    1579              :              *
    1580              :              * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
    1581              :              * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called.  The lack of
    1582              :              * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
    1583              :              * "unused" that have since become used.  This is fine because
    1584              :              * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
    1585              :              * want to wait on anyway.  Not taking a lock to acquire the
    1586              :              * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
    1587              :              * insertingAt values.  This is also fine, because if we read a
    1588              :              * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
    1589              :              * contains atomic operations.
    1590              :              */
    1591      3984661 :             if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1592      3984661 :                                  &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1593              :                                  insertingat, &insertingat))
    1594              :             {
    1595              :                 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
    1596      2653723 :                 insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1597      2653723 :                 break;
    1598              :             }
    1599              : 
    1600              :             /*
    1601              :              * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
    1602              :              * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
    1603              :              */
    1604      1330938 :         } while (insertingat < upto);
    1605              : 
    1606      3861672 :         if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(insertingat) && insertingat < finishedUpto)
    1607       427358 :             finishedUpto = insertingat;
    1608              :     }
    1609              : 
    1610              :     /*
    1611              :      * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
    1612              :      * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
    1613              :      * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
    1614              :      */
    1615       482709 :     finishedUpto = pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult,
    1616              :                                                    finishedUpto);
    1617              : 
    1618       482709 :     return finishedUpto;
    1619              : }
    1620              : 
    1621              : /*
    1622              :  * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
    1623              :  * given XLogRecPtr.
    1624              :  *
    1625              :  * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
    1626              :  * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
    1627              :  *
    1628              :  * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
    1629              :  * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
    1630              :  * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
    1631              :  * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
    1632              :  * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
    1633              :  * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
    1634              :  * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
    1635              :  * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
    1636              :  */
    1637              : static char *
    1638     17937926 : GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
    1639              : {
    1640              :     int         idx;
    1641              :     XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    1642              :     static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
    1643              :     static char *cachedPos = NULL;
    1644              :     XLogRecPtr  expectedEndPtr;
    1645              : 
    1646              :     /*
    1647              :      * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
    1648              :      * page as last time.
    1649              :      */
    1650     17937926 :     if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
    1651              :     {
    1652              :         Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
    1653              :         Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
    1654     15019160 :         return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1655              :     }
    1656              : 
    1657              :     /*
    1658              :      * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
    1659              :      * particular buffer.  That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
    1660              :      * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
    1661              :      */
    1662      2918766 :     idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
    1663              : 
    1664              :     /*
    1665              :      * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
    1666              :      * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
    1667              :      * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
    1668              :      * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
    1669              :      * that doesn't happen.
    1670              :      *
    1671              :      * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
    1672              :      * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
    1673              :      * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
    1674              :      * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
    1675              :      * we're looking for.
    1676              :      */
    1677      2918766 :     expectedEndPtr = ptr;
    1678      2918766 :     expectedEndPtr += XLOG_BLCKSZ - ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1679              : 
    1680      2918766 :     endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1681      2918766 :     if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1682              :     {
    1683              :         XLogRecPtr  initializedUpto;
    1684              : 
    1685              :         /*
    1686              :          * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
    1687              :          * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
    1688              :          *
    1689              :          * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
    1690              :          * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
    1691              :          * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
    1692              :          * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
    1693              :          * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
    1694              :          * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
    1695              :          * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
    1696              :          * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
    1697              :          * the page header.
    1698              :          */
    1699      2509602 :         if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
    1700         6676 :             XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) > XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1701         6676 :             initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1702      2502926 :         else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
    1703          989 :                  XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) < XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1704          604 :             initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1705              :         else
    1706      2502322 :             initializedUpto = ptr;
    1707              : 
    1708      2509602 :         WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(initializedUpto);
    1709              : 
    1710      2509602 :         AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
    1711      2509602 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1712              : 
    1713      2509602 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1714            0 :             elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
    1715              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
    1716              :     }
    1717              :     else
    1718              :     {
    1719              :         /*
    1720              :          * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
    1721              :          * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
    1722              :          */
    1723       409164 :         pg_memory_barrier();
    1724              :     }
    1725              : 
    1726              :     /*
    1727              :      * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
    1728              :      * offset within the page.
    1729              :      */
    1730      2918766 :     cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1731      2918766 :     cachedPos = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1732              : 
    1733              :     Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
    1734              :     Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
    1735              : 
    1736      2918766 :     return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1737              : }
    1738              : 
    1739              : /*
    1740              :  * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
    1741              :  * of bytes read successfully.
    1742              :  *
    1743              :  * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
    1744              :  * already been evicted.
    1745              :  *
    1746              :  * No locks are taken.
    1747              :  *
    1748              :  * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
    1749              :  * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
    1750              :  * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
    1751              :  * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
    1752              :  */
    1753              : Size
    1754        98830 : WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count,
    1755              :                    TimeLineID tli)
    1756              : {
    1757        98830 :     char       *pdst = dstbuf;
    1758        98830 :     XLogRecPtr  recptr = startptr;
    1759              :     XLogRecPtr  inserted;
    1760        98830 :     Size        nbytes = count;
    1761              : 
    1762        98830 :     if (RecoveryInProgress() || tli != GetWALInsertionTimeLine())
    1763          901 :         return 0;
    1764              : 
    1765              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
    1766              : 
    1767              :     /*
    1768              :      * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
    1769              :      * buffers before we try to read it.
    1770              :      */
    1771        97929 :     inserted = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    1772        97929 :     if (startptr + count > inserted)
    1773            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1774              :                 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
    1775              :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
    1776              :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(inserted)));
    1777              : 
    1778              :     /*
    1779              :      * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
    1780              :      * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
    1781              :      * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
    1782              :      *
    1783              :      * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
    1784              :      * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
    1785              :      * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
    1786              :      * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
    1787              :      * happens between the two verification steps.
    1788              :      *
    1789              :      * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
    1790              :      * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
    1791              :      */
    1792       109660 :     while (nbytes > 0)
    1793              :     {
    1794       106050 :         uint32      offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1795       106050 :         int         idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr);
    1796              :         XLogRecPtr  expectedEndPtr;
    1797              :         XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    1798              :         const char *page;
    1799              :         const char *psrc;
    1800              :         Size        npagebytes;
    1801              : 
    1802              :         /*
    1803              :          * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
    1804              :          * correct page is present.
    1805              :          */
    1806       106050 :         expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
    1807              : 
    1808              :         /*
    1809              :          * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
    1810              :          * the WAL buffers.
    1811              :          */
    1812       106050 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1813       106050 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1814        94318 :             break;
    1815              : 
    1816              :         /*
    1817              :          * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
    1818              :          * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
    1819              :          * determine how much data to read from this page.
    1820              :          */
    1821        11732 :         page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1822        11732 :         psrc = page + offset;
    1823        11732 :         npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
    1824              : 
    1825              :         /*
    1826              :          * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
    1827              :          * reordered.
    1828              :          */
    1829        11732 :         pg_read_barrier();
    1830              : 
    1831              :         /* data copy */
    1832        11732 :         memcpy(pdst, psrc, npagebytes);
    1833              : 
    1834              :         /*
    1835              :          * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
    1836              :          * reordered.
    1837              :          */
    1838        11732 :         pg_read_barrier();
    1839              : 
    1840              :         /*
    1841              :          * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
    1842              :          * evicted while we were copying the data.
    1843              :          */
    1844        11732 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1845        11732 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1846            1 :             break;
    1847              : 
    1848        11731 :         pdst += npagebytes;
    1849        11731 :         recptr += npagebytes;
    1850        11731 :         nbytes -= npagebytes;
    1851              :     }
    1852              : 
    1853              :     Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
    1854              : 
    1855        97929 :     return pdst - dstbuf;
    1856              : }
    1857              : 
    1858              : /*
    1859              :  * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
    1860              :  * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
    1861              :  * page headers.
    1862              :  */
    1863              : static XLogRecPtr
    1864     30788588 : XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
    1865              : {
    1866              :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1867              :     uint64      fullpages;
    1868              :     uint64      bytesleft;
    1869              :     uint32      seg_offset;
    1870              :     XLogRecPtr  result;
    1871              : 
    1872     30788588 :     fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
    1873     30788588 :     bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
    1874              : 
    1875     30788588 :     if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
    1876              :     {
    1877              :         /* fits on first page of segment */
    1878        60319 :         seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1879              :     }
    1880              :     else
    1881              :     {
    1882              :         /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
    1883     30728269 :         seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1884     30728269 :         bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1885              : 
    1886     30728269 :         fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
    1887     30728269 :         bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
    1888              : 
    1889     30728269 :         seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1890              :     }
    1891              : 
    1892     30788588 :     XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
    1893              : 
    1894     30788588 :     return result;
    1895              : }
    1896              : 
    1897              : /*
    1898              :  * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
    1899              :  * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
    1900              :  * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
    1901              :  * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
    1902              :  */
    1903              : static XLogRecPtr
    1904     15876459 : XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
    1905              : {
    1906              :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1907              :     uint64      fullpages;
    1908              :     uint64      bytesleft;
    1909              :     uint32      seg_offset;
    1910              :     XLogRecPtr  result;
    1911              : 
    1912     15876459 :     fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
    1913     15876459 :     bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
    1914              : 
    1915     15876459 :     if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
    1916              :     {
    1917              :         /* fits on first page of segment */
    1918       100673 :         if (bytesleft == 0)
    1919        69152 :             seg_offset = 0;
    1920              :         else
    1921        31521 :             seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1922              :     }
    1923              :     else
    1924              :     {
    1925              :         /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
    1926     15775786 :         seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1927     15775786 :         bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1928              : 
    1929     15775786 :         fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
    1930     15775786 :         bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
    1931              : 
    1932     15775786 :         if (bytesleft == 0)
    1933        15412 :             seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft;
    1934              :         else
    1935     15760374 :             seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1936              :     }
    1937              : 
    1938     15876459 :     XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
    1939              : 
    1940     15876459 :     return result;
    1941              : }
    1942              : 
    1943              : /*
    1944              :  * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
    1945              :  */
    1946              : static uint64
    1947         2621 : XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
    1948              : {
    1949              :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1950              :     uint32      fullpages;
    1951              :     uint32      offset;
    1952              :     uint64      result;
    1953              : 
    1954         2621 :     XLByteToSeg(ptr, fullsegs, wal_segment_size);
    1955              : 
    1956         2621 :     fullpages = (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size)) / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1957         2621 :     offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1958              : 
    1959         2621 :     if (fullpages == 0)
    1960              :     {
    1961         1023 :         result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
    1962         1023 :         if (offset > 0)
    1963              :         {
    1964              :             Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
    1965          263 :             result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1966              :         }
    1967              :     }
    1968              :     else
    1969              :     {
    1970         1598 :         result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
    1971         1598 :             (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
    1972         1598 :             (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage;    /* full pages */
    1973         1598 :         if (offset > 0)
    1974              :         {
    1975              :             Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    1976         1588 :             result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1977              :         }
    1978              :     }
    1979              : 
    1980         2621 :     return result;
    1981              : }
    1982              : 
    1983              : /*
    1984              :  * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
    1985              :  * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
    1986              :  * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
    1987              :  * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
    1988              :  * initialized properly.
    1989              :  */
    1990              : static void
    1991      2514448 : AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
    1992              : {
    1993      2514448 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1994              :     int         nextidx;
    1995              :     XLogRecPtr  OldPageRqstPtr;
    1996              :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    1997      2514448 :     XLogRecPtr  NewPageEndPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1998              :     XLogRecPtr  NewPageBeginPtr;
    1999              :     XLogPageHeader NewPage;
    2000      2514448 :     int         npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
    2001              : 
    2002      2514448 :     LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2003              : 
    2004              :     /*
    2005              :      * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
    2006              :      * already.
    2007              :      */
    2008      7343128 :     while (upto >= XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo || opportunistic)
    2009              :     {
    2010      4833526 :         nextidx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo);
    2011              : 
    2012              :         /*
    2013              :          * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
    2014              :          * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet).  Fall through if it's
    2015              :          * already written out.
    2016              :          */
    2017      4833526 :         OldPageRqstPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]);
    2018      4833526 :         if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2019              :         {
    2020              :             /*
    2021              :              * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
    2022              :              * as we can without flushing, give up now.
    2023              :              */
    2024      2240800 :             if (opportunistic)
    2025         4846 :                 break;
    2026              : 
    2027              :             /* Advance shared memory write request position */
    2028      2235954 :             SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2029      2235954 :             if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2030       680129 :                 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
    2031      2235954 :             SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2032              : 
    2033              :             /*
    2034              :              * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
    2035              :              * need to write it or if someone else already did.
    2036              :              */
    2037      2235954 :             RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2038      2235954 :             if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2039              :             {
    2040              :                 /*
    2041              :                  * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
    2042              :                  * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
    2043              :                  * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
    2044              :                  * deadlock.
    2045              :                  */
    2046      2219092 :                 LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
    2047              : 
    2048      2219092 :                 WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(OldPageRqstPtr);
    2049              : 
    2050      2219092 :                 LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2051              : 
    2052      2219092 :                 RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2053      2219092 :                 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= OldPageRqstPtr)
    2054              :                 {
    2055              :                     /* OK, someone wrote it already */
    2056       148989 :                     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2057              :                 }
    2058              :                 else
    2059              :                 {
    2060              :                     /* Have to write it ourselves */
    2061              :                     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_START();
    2062      2070103 :                     WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
    2063      2070103 :                     WriteRqst.Flush = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    2064      2070103 :                     XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
    2065      2070103 :                     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2066      2070103 :                     pgWalUsage.wal_buffers_full++;
    2067              :                     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_DONE();
    2068              : 
    2069              :                     /*
    2070              :                      * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
    2071              :                      * update of pgWalUsage.
    2072              :                      */
    2073      2070103 :                     pgstat_report_fixed = true;
    2074              :                 }
    2075              :                 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
    2076      2219092 :                 LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2077      2219092 :                 continue;
    2078              :             }
    2079              :         }
    2080              : 
    2081              :         /*
    2082              :          * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
    2083              :          * next output page.
    2084              :          */
    2085      2609588 :         NewPageBeginPtr = XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo;
    2086      2609588 :         NewPageEndPtr = NewPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2087              : 
    2088              :         Assert(XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(NewPageBeginPtr) == nextidx);
    2089              : 
    2090      2609588 :         NewPage = (XLogPageHeader) (XLogCtl->pages + nextidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    2091              : 
    2092              :         /*
    2093              :          * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
    2094              :          * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
    2095              :          * zeroed but look valid.
    2096              :          */
    2097      2609588 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    2098      2609588 :         pg_write_barrier();
    2099              : 
    2100              :         /*
    2101              :          * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
    2102              :          * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
    2103              :          */
    2104      2609588 :         MemSet(NewPage, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    2105              : 
    2106              :         /*
    2107              :          * Fill the new page's header
    2108              :          */
    2109      2609588 :         NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
    2110              : 
    2111              :         /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
    2112      2609588 :         NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
    2113      2609588 :         NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
    2114              : 
    2115              :         /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */  /* done by memset */
    2116              : 
    2117              :         /*
    2118              :          * If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate
    2119              :          * that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup
    2120              :          * blocks.  This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to
    2121              :          * compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into
    2122              :          * the non-full-block format.  It is sufficient to record this at the
    2123              :          * page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment
    2124              :          * switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any
    2125              :          * records can be written during the backup.  At the end of a backup,
    2126              :          * the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part
    2127              :          * is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to
    2128              :          * compress a few records.
    2129              :          */
    2130      2609588 :         if (Insert->runningBackups == 0)
    2131      2468005 :             NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE;
    2132              : 
    2133              :         /*
    2134              :          * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
    2135              :          */
    2136      2609588 :         if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
    2137              :         {
    2138         1809 :             XLogLongPageHeader NewLongPage = (XLogLongPageHeader) NewPage;
    2139              : 
    2140         1809 :             NewLongPage->xlp_sysid = ControlFile->system_identifier;
    2141         1809 :             NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    2142         1809 :             NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2143         1809 :             NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
    2144              :         }
    2145              : 
    2146              :         /*
    2147              :          * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
    2148              :          * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
    2149              :          * holding a lock.
    2150              :          */
    2151      2609588 :         pg_write_barrier();
    2152              : 
    2153      2609588 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], NewPageEndPtr);
    2154      2609588 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = NewPageEndPtr;
    2155              : 
    2156      2609588 :         npages++;
    2157              :     }
    2158      2514448 :     LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
    2159              : 
    2160              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    2161              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
    2162              :     {
    2163              :         elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
    2164              :              npages, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(NewPageEndPtr));
    2165              :     }
    2166              : #endif
    2167      2514448 : }
    2168              : 
    2169              : /*
    2170              :  * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
    2171              :  * checkpoint_completion_target.
    2172              :  */
    2173              : static void
    2174         8275 : CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
    2175              : {
    2176              :     double      target;
    2177              : 
    2178              :     /*-------
    2179              :      * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
    2180              :      * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
    2181              :      *
    2182              :      * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
    2183              :      *    WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
    2184              :      *    secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
    2185              :      *    only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
    2186              :      *    one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
    2187              :      *    many smaller databases.)
    2188              :      * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
    2189              :      *    number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
    2190              :      *-------
    2191              :      */
    2192         8275 :     target = (double) ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) /
    2193         8275 :         (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget);
    2194              : 
    2195              :     /* round down */
    2196         8275 :     CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
    2197              : 
    2198         8275 :     if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
    2199           10 :         CheckPointSegments = 1;
    2200         8275 : }
    2201              : 
    2202              : void
    2203         6031 : assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
    2204              : {
    2205         6031 :     max_wal_size_mb = newval;
    2206         6031 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    2207         6031 : }
    2208              : 
    2209              : void
    2210         1188 : assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
    2211              : {
    2212         1188 :     CheckPointCompletionTarget = newval;
    2213         1188 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    2214         1188 : }
    2215              : 
    2216              : bool
    2217         2296 : check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    2218              : {
    2219         2296 :     if (!IsValidWalSegSize(*newval))
    2220              :     {
    2221            0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
    2222            0 :         return false;
    2223              :     }
    2224              : 
    2225         2296 :     return true;
    2226              : }
    2227              : 
    2228              : /*
    2229              :  * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
    2230              :  * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
    2231              :  */
    2232              : static XLogSegNo
    2233         1796 : XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
    2234              : {
    2235              :     XLogSegNo   minSegNo;
    2236              :     XLogSegNo   maxSegNo;
    2237              :     double      distance;
    2238              :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    2239              : 
    2240              :     /*
    2241              :      * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
    2242              :      * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
    2243              :      * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
    2244              :      */
    2245         1796 :     minSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
    2246         1796 :         ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
    2247         1796 :     maxSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
    2248         1796 :         ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
    2249              : 
    2250              :     /*
    2251              :      * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
    2252              :      * estimated end of next checkpoint.
    2253              :      *
    2254              :      * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
    2255              :      * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
    2256              :      * every checkpoint.
    2257              :      */
    2258         1796 :     distance = (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget) * CheckPointDistanceEstimate;
    2259              :     /* add 10% for good measure. */
    2260         1796 :     distance *= 1.10;
    2261              : 
    2262         1796 :     recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
    2263              :                                     wal_segment_size);
    2264              : 
    2265         1796 :     if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
    2266         1271 :         recycleSegNo = minSegNo;
    2267         1796 :     if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
    2268          399 :         recycleSegNo = maxSegNo;
    2269              : 
    2270         1796 :     return recycleSegNo;
    2271              : }
    2272              : 
    2273              : /*
    2274              :  * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
    2275              :  *
    2276              :  * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
    2277              :  * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
    2278              :  * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
    2279              :  *
    2280              :  * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
    2281              :  */
    2282              : bool
    2283         4916 : XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
    2284              : {
    2285              :     XLogSegNo   old_segno;
    2286              : 
    2287         4916 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, old_segno, wal_segment_size);
    2288              : 
    2289         4916 :     if (new_segno >= old_segno + (uint64) (CheckPointSegments - 1))
    2290         3113 :         return true;
    2291         1803 :     return false;
    2292              : }
    2293              : 
    2294              : /*
    2295              :  * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
    2296              :  *
    2297              :  * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
    2298              :  * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
    2299              :  * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
    2300              :  * single one would do.
    2301              :  *
    2302              :  * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
    2303              :  * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
    2304              :  * write.
    2305              :  */
    2306              : static void
    2307      2205844 : XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
    2308              : {
    2309              :     bool        ispartialpage;
    2310              :     bool        last_iteration;
    2311              :     bool        finishing_seg;
    2312              :     int         curridx;
    2313              :     int         npages;
    2314              :     int         startidx;
    2315              :     uint32      startoffset;
    2316              : 
    2317              :     /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
    2318              :     Assert(CritSectionCount > 0);
    2319              : 
    2320              :     /*
    2321              :      * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
    2322              :      */
    2323      2205844 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2324              : 
    2325              :     /*
    2326              :      * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
    2327              :      * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
    2328              :      * write() call.  npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
    2329              :      * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
    2330              :      * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
    2331              :      * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
    2332              :      * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
    2333              :      */
    2334      2205844 :     npages = 0;
    2335      2205844 :     startidx = 0;
    2336      2205844 :     startoffset = 0;
    2337              : 
    2338              :     /*
    2339              :      * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
    2340              :      * consider writing.  Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
    2341              :      * page, or last partially written page.
    2342              :      */
    2343      2205844 :     curridx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(LogwrtResult.Write);
    2344              : 
    2345      4752694 :     while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
    2346              :     {
    2347              :         /*
    2348              :          * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process.  This could happen
    2349              :          * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
    2350              :          * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
    2351              :          */
    2352      2677261 :         XLogRecPtr  EndPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[curridx]);
    2353              : 
    2354      2677261 :         if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
    2355            0 :             elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
    2356              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    2357              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPtr));
    2358              : 
    2359              :         /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
    2360      2677261 :         LogwrtResult.Write = EndPtr;
    2361      2677261 :         ispartialpage = WriteRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write;
    2362              : 
    2363      2677261 :         if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2364              :                              wal_segment_size))
    2365              :         {
    2366              :             /*
    2367              :              * Switch to new logfile segment.  We cannot have any pending
    2368              :              * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
    2369              :              */
    2370              :             Assert(npages == 0);
    2371        13796 :             if (openLogFile >= 0)
    2372         6178 :                 XLogFileClose();
    2373        13796 :             XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2374              :                             wal_segment_size);
    2375        13796 :             openLogTLI = tli;
    2376              : 
    2377              :             /* create/use new log file */
    2378        13796 :             openLogFile = XLogFileInit(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2379        13796 :             ReserveExternalFD();
    2380              :         }
    2381              : 
    2382              :         /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
    2383      2677261 :         if (openLogFile < 0)
    2384              :         {
    2385            0 :             XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2386              :                             wal_segment_size);
    2387            0 :             openLogTLI = tli;
    2388            0 :             openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2389            0 :             ReserveExternalFD();
    2390              :         }
    2391              : 
    2392              :         /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
    2393      2677261 :         if (npages == 0)
    2394              :         {
    2395              :             /* first of group */
    2396      2218568 :             startidx = curridx;
    2397      2218568 :             startoffset = XLogSegmentOffset(LogwrtResult.Write - XLOG_BLCKSZ,
    2398              :                                             wal_segment_size);
    2399              :         }
    2400      2677261 :         npages++;
    2401              : 
    2402              :         /*
    2403              :          * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
    2404              :          * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
    2405              :          * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
    2406              :          * segment.
    2407              :          */
    2408      2677261 :         last_iteration = WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Write;
    2409              : 
    2410      5227853 :         finishing_seg = !ispartialpage &&
    2411      2550592 :             (startoffset + npages * XLOG_BLCKSZ) >= wal_segment_size;
    2412              : 
    2413      2677261 :         if (last_iteration ||
    2414       473728 :             curridx == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck ||
    2415              :             finishing_seg)
    2416              :         {
    2417              :             char       *from;
    2418              :             Size        nbytes;
    2419              :             Size        nleft;
    2420              :             ssize_t     written;
    2421              :             instr_time  start;
    2422              : 
    2423              :             /* OK to write the page(s) */
    2424      2218568 :             from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2425      2218568 :             nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2426      2218568 :             nleft = nbytes;
    2427              :             do
    2428              :             {
    2429      2218568 :                 errno = 0;
    2430              : 
    2431              :                 /*
    2432              :                  * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
    2433              :                  */
    2434      2218568 :                 start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    2435              : 
    2436      2218568 :                 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_WRITE);
    2437      2218568 :                 written = pg_pwrite(openLogFile, from, nleft, startoffset);
    2438      2218568 :                 pgstat_report_wait_end();
    2439              : 
    2440      2218568 :                 pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_NORMAL,
    2441              :                                         IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
    2442              : 
    2443      2218568 :                 if (written <= 0)
    2444              :                 {
    2445              :                     char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    2446              :                     int         save_errno;
    2447              : 
    2448            0 :                     if (errno == EINTR)
    2449            0 :                         continue;
    2450              : 
    2451            0 :                     save_errno = errno;
    2452            0 :                     XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, openLogSegNo,
    2453              :                                  wal_segment_size);
    2454            0 :                     errno = save_errno;
    2455            0 :                     ereport(PANIC,
    2456              :                             (errcode_for_file_access(),
    2457              :                              errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
    2458              :                                     xlogfname, startoffset, nleft)));
    2459              :                 }
    2460      2218568 :                 nleft -= written;
    2461      2218568 :                 from += written;
    2462      2218568 :                 startoffset += written;
    2463      2218568 :             } while (nleft > 0);
    2464              : 
    2465      2218568 :             npages = 0;
    2466              : 
    2467              :             /*
    2468              :              * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
    2469              :              * fsync the segment immediately.  This avoids having to go back
    2470              :              * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
    2471              :              * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
    2472              :              * perform this fsync.
    2473              :              *
    2474              :              * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
    2475              :              * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
    2476              :              * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
    2477              :              * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
    2478              :              * checkpoint.
    2479              :              */
    2480      2218568 :             if (finishing_seg)
    2481              :             {
    2482         1932 :                 issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo, tli);
    2483              : 
    2484              :                 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
    2485         1932 :                 WalSndWakeupRequest();
    2486              : 
    2487         1932 :                 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;    /* end of page */
    2488              : 
    2489         1932 :                 if (XLogArchivingActive())
    2490          409 :                     XLogArchiveNotifySeg(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2491              : 
    2492         1932 :                 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    2493         1932 :                 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = LogwrtResult.Flush;
    2494              : 
    2495              :                 /*
    2496              :                  * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
    2497              :                  * the last one.  For speed, we first check using the local
    2498              :                  * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
    2499              :                  * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
    2500              :                  * recheck.
    2501              :                  */
    2502         1932 :                 if (IsUnderPostmaster && XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
    2503              :                 {
    2504          261 :                     (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
    2505          261 :                     if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
    2506          212 :                         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG);
    2507              :                 }
    2508              :             }
    2509              :         }
    2510              : 
    2511      2677261 :         if (ispartialpage)
    2512              :         {
    2513              :             /* Only asked to write a partial page */
    2514       126669 :             LogwrtResult.Write = WriteRqst.Write;
    2515       126669 :             break;
    2516              :         }
    2517      2550592 :         curridx = NextBufIdx(curridx);
    2518              : 
    2519              :         /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
    2520      2550592 :         if (flexible && npages == 0)
    2521         3742 :             break;
    2522              :     }
    2523              : 
    2524              :     Assert(npages == 0);
    2525              : 
    2526              :     /*
    2527              :      * If asked to flush, do so
    2528              :      */
    2529      2205844 :     if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
    2530       134980 :         LogwrtResult.Flush < LogwrtResult.Write)
    2531              :     {
    2532              :         /*
    2533              :          * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
    2534              :          * have no open file or the wrong one.  However, we do not need to
    2535              :          * fsync more than one file.
    2536              :          */
    2537       134913 :         if (wal_sync_method != WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN &&
    2538       134913 :             wal_sync_method != WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
    2539              :         {
    2540       134913 :             if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
    2541       134890 :                 !XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2542              :                                  wal_segment_size))
    2543          199 :                 XLogFileClose();
    2544       134913 :             if (openLogFile < 0)
    2545              :             {
    2546          222 :                 XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2547              :                                 wal_segment_size);
    2548          222 :                 openLogTLI = tli;
    2549          222 :                 openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2550          222 :                 ReserveExternalFD();
    2551              :             }
    2552              : 
    2553       134913 :             issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo, tli);
    2554              :         }
    2555              : 
    2556              :         /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
    2557       134913 :         WalSndWakeupRequest();
    2558              : 
    2559       134913 :         LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;
    2560              :     }
    2561              : 
    2562              :     /*
    2563              :      * Update shared-memory status
    2564              :      *
    2565              :      * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
    2566              :      * 'result' values.  This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
    2567              :      * code in a couple of places.
    2568              :      */
    2569      2205844 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2570      2205844 :     if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write)
    2571       118042 :         XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = LogwrtResult.Write;
    2572      2205844 :     if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush < LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2573       136475 :         XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = LogwrtResult.Flush;
    2574      2205844 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2575              : 
    2576              :     /*
    2577              :      * We write Write first, bar, then Flush.  When reading, the opposite must
    2578              :      * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
    2579              :      * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
    2580              :      */
    2581      2205844 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, LogwrtResult.Write);
    2582      2205844 :     pg_write_barrier();
    2583      2205844 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    2584              : 
    2585              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    2586              :     {
    2587              :         XLogRecPtr  Flush;
    2588              :         XLogRecPtr  Write;
    2589              :         XLogRecPtr  Insert;
    2590              : 
    2591              :         Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult);
    2592              :         pg_read_barrier();
    2593              :         Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult);
    2594              :         pg_read_barrier();
    2595              :         Insert = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    2596              : 
    2597              :         /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
    2598              :         Assert(Write >= Flush);
    2599              : 
    2600              :         /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
    2601              :         Assert(Insert >= Write);
    2602              :     }
    2603              : #endif
    2604      2205844 : }
    2605              : 
    2606              : /*
    2607              :  * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
    2608              :  * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
    2609              :  * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
    2610              :  */
    2611              : void
    2612        49488 : XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
    2613              : {
    2614        49488 :     XLogRecPtr  WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
    2615              :     bool        sleeping;
    2616        49488 :     bool        wakeup = false;
    2617              :     XLogRecPtr  prevAsyncXactLSN;
    2618              : 
    2619        49488 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2620        49488 :     sleeping = XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping;
    2621        49488 :     prevAsyncXactLSN = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
    2622        49488 :     if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
    2623        48985 :         XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
    2624        49488 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2625              : 
    2626              :     /*
    2627              :      * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
    2628              :      * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
    2629              :      */
    2630        49488 :     if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
    2631          503 :         return;
    2632              : 
    2633              :     /*
    2634              :      * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
    2635              :      * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
    2636              :      * amount of time.  Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
    2637              :      * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
    2638              :      */
    2639        48985 :     if (sleeping)
    2640           20 :         wakeup = true;
    2641              :     else
    2642              :     {
    2643              :         int         flushblocks;
    2644              : 
    2645        48965 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2646              : 
    2647        48965 :         flushblocks =
    2648        48965 :             WriteRqstPtr / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2649              : 
    2650        48965 :         if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
    2651         4031 :             wakeup = true;
    2652              :     }
    2653              : 
    2654        48985 :     if (wakeup)
    2655              :     {
    2656         4051 :         volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
    2657         4051 :         ProcNumber  walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
    2658              : 
    2659         4051 :         if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
    2660          224 :             SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
    2661              :     }
    2662              : }
    2663              : 
    2664              : /*
    2665              :  * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
    2666              :  * any replication slot.
    2667              :  */
    2668              : void
    2669        34987 : XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
    2670              : {
    2671        34987 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2672        34987 :     XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN = lsn;
    2673        34987 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2674        34987 : }
    2675              : 
    2676              : 
    2677              : /*
    2678              :  * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
    2679              :  * replication slot.
    2680              :  */
    2681              : XLogRecPtr
    2682         2427 : XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
    2683              : {
    2684              :     XLogRecPtr  retval;
    2685              : 
    2686         2427 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2687         2427 :     retval = XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN;
    2688         2427 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2689              : 
    2690         2427 :     return retval;
    2691              : }
    2692              : 
    2693              : /*
    2694              :  * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
    2695              :  *
    2696              :  * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
    2697              :  * database is consistent.
    2698              :  *
    2699              :  * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
    2700              :  * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
    2701              :  */
    2702              : static void
    2703       113265 : UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
    2704              : {
    2705              :     /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
    2706       113265 :     if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    2707       106104 :         return;
    2708              : 
    2709              :     /*
    2710              :      * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
    2711              :      * i.e., we're doing crash recovery.  We never modify the control file's
    2712              :      * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
    2713              :      * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
    2714              :      * updated until crash recovery finishes.  We only do this for the startup
    2715              :      * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
    2716              :      * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
    2717              :      * available is replayed in this case.  This also saves from extra locks
    2718              :      * taken on the control file from the startup process.
    2719              :      */
    2720         7161 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
    2721              :     {
    2722           31 :         updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    2723           31 :         return;
    2724              :     }
    2725              : 
    2726         7130 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2727              : 
    2728              :     /* update local copy */
    2729         7130 :     LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    2730         7130 :     LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    2731              : 
    2732         7130 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    2733            2 :         updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    2734         7128 :     else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    2735              :     {
    2736              :         XLogRecPtr  newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2737              :         TimeLineID  newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2738              : 
    2739              :         /*
    2740              :          * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
    2741              :          * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
    2742              :          * would suffice for correctness.  This also allows the 'force' case
    2743              :          * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
    2744              :          *
    2745              :          * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
    2746              :          * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
    2747              :          * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page.  Accepting such a
    2748              :          * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
    2749              :          * all.  Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
    2750              :          * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
    2751              :          */
    2752         5653 :         newMinRecoveryPoint = GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&newMinRecoveryPointTLI);
    2753         5653 :         if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    2754            0 :             elog(WARNING,
    2755              :                  "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
    2756              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint));
    2757              : 
    2758              :         /* update control file */
    2759         5653 :         if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < newMinRecoveryPoint)
    2760              :         {
    2761         5305 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2762         5305 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2763         5305 :             UpdateControlFile();
    2764         5305 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2765         5305 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2766              : 
    2767         5305 :             ereport(DEBUG2,
    2768              :                     errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
    2769              :                                     LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint),
    2770              :                                     newMinRecoveryPointTLI));
    2771              :         }
    2772              :     }
    2773         7130 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    2774              : }
    2775              : 
    2776              : /*
    2777              :  * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
    2778              :  *
    2779              :  * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
    2780              :  * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
    2781              :  */
    2782              : void
    2783       719064 : XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
    2784              : {
    2785              :     XLogRecPtr  WriteRqstPtr;
    2786              :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    2787       719064 :     TimeLineID  insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    2788              : 
    2789              :     /*
    2790              :      * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL.  Therefore, instead of
    2791              :      * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
    2792              :      * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
    2793              :      * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
    2794              :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
    2795              :      */
    2796       719064 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
    2797              :     {
    2798       112825 :         UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
    2799       574194 :         return;
    2800              :     }
    2801              : 
    2802              :     /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
    2803       606239 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2804       461369 :         return;
    2805              : 
    2806              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    2807              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    2808              :         elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
    2809              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
    2810              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    2811              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    2812              : #endif
    2813              : 
    2814       144870 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    2815              : 
    2816              :     /*
    2817              :      * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
    2818              :      * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
    2819              :      * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
    2820              :      * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
    2821              :      * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
    2822              :      */
    2823              : 
    2824              :     /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
    2825       144870 :     WriteRqstPtr = record;
    2826              : 
    2827              :     /*
    2828              :      * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
    2829              :      * for us.
    2830              :      */
    2831              :     for (;;)
    2832         3535 :     {
    2833              :         XLogRecPtr  insertpos;
    2834              : 
    2835              :         /* done already? */
    2836       148405 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2837       148405 :         if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2838        10675 :             break;
    2839              : 
    2840              :         /*
    2841              :          * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
    2842              :          * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
    2843              :          */
    2844       137730 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2845       137730 :         if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
    2846         9603 :             WriteRqstPtr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
    2847       137730 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2848       137730 :         insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqstPtr);
    2849              : 
    2850              :         /*
    2851              :          * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
    2852              :          * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
    2853              :          * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
    2854              :          * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
    2855              :          * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
    2856              :          */
    2857       137730 :         if (!LWLockAcquireOrWait(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE))
    2858              :         {
    2859              :             /*
    2860              :              * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
    2861              :              * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
    2862              :              * us already.
    2863              :              */
    2864         3535 :             continue;
    2865              :         }
    2866              : 
    2867              :         /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
    2868       134195 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2869       134195 :         if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2870              :         {
    2871         3139 :             LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2872         3139 :             break;
    2873              :         }
    2874              : 
    2875              :         /*
    2876              :          * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
    2877              :          * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
    2878              :          * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
    2879              :          * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
    2880              :          *
    2881              :          * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
    2882              :          * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
    2883              :          */
    2884       131056 :         if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
    2885            0 :             MinimumActiveBackends(CommitSiblings))
    2886              :         {
    2887            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_COMMIT_DELAY);
    2888            0 :             pg_usleep(CommitDelay);
    2889            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    2890              : 
    2891              :             /*
    2892              :              * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
    2893              :              * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
    2894              :              * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
    2895              :              * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
    2896              :              * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
    2897              :              * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
    2898              :              * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
    2899              :              * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
    2900              :              */
    2901            0 :             insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(insertpos);
    2902              :         }
    2903              : 
    2904              :         /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
    2905       131056 :         WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
    2906       131056 :         WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
    2907              : 
    2908       131056 :         XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
    2909              : 
    2910       131056 :         LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2911              :         /* done */
    2912       131056 :         break;
    2913              :     }
    2914              : 
    2915       144870 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    2916              : 
    2917              :     /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
    2918       144870 :     WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(true, !RecoveryInProgress());
    2919              : 
    2920              :     /*
    2921              :      * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
    2922              :      */
    2923       289740 :     if (waitLSNState &&
    2924       144870 :         (LogwrtResult.Flush >=
    2925       144870 :          pg_atomic_read_u64(&waitLSNState->minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH])))
    2926            0 :         WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    2927              : 
    2928              :     /*
    2929              :      * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
    2930              :      * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
    2931              :      * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
    2932              :      *
    2933              :      * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
    2934              :      * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
    2935              :      * the whole system due to corruption on one data page.  In particular, if
    2936              :      * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
    2937              :      * unable to restart the database at all!  (This scenario actually
    2938              :      * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.)  As of 8.4, bad
    2939              :      * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
    2940              :      * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
    2941              :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
    2942              :      * bad LSN.
    2943              :      *
    2944              :      * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
    2945              :      * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section.  However,
    2946              :      * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
    2947              :      * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
    2948              :      */
    2949       144870 :     if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
    2950            0 :         elog(ERROR,
    2951              :              "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
    2952              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
    2953              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    2954              : 
    2955              :     /*
    2956              :      * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush().  Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
    2957              :      * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
    2958              :      * remain consistent.
    2959              :      */
    2960              :     Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
    2961              : }
    2962              : 
    2963              : /*
    2964              :  * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
    2965              :  *
    2966              :  * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
    2967              :  * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
    2968              :  * block, and write through the latest one of those.  Thus, if async commits
    2969              :  * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
    2970              :  *
    2971              :  * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
    2972              :  * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
    2973              :  * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
    2974              :  * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
    2975              :  *
    2976              :  * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
    2977              :  * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
    2978              :  * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
    2979              :  * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
    2980              :  * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
    2981              :  *
    2982              :  * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
    2983              :  *
    2984              :  * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
    2985              :  * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
    2986              :  */
    2987              : bool
    2988        15272 : XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
    2989              : {
    2990              :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    2991        15272 :     bool        flexible = true;
    2992              :     static TimestampTz lastflush;
    2993              :     TimestampTz now;
    2994              :     int         flushblocks;
    2995              :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
    2996              : 
    2997              :     /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
    2998        15272 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    2999            4 :         return false;
    3000              : 
    3001              :     /*
    3002              :      * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
    3003              :      * so we can read it without a lock.
    3004              :      */
    3005        15268 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    3006              : 
    3007              :     /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
    3008        15268 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3009        15268 :     WriteRqst = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst;
    3010        15268 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3011              : 
    3012              :     /* back off to last completed page boundary */
    3013        15268 :     WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    3014              : 
    3015              :     /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
    3016        15268 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3017        15268 :     if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3018              :     {
    3019        11202 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3020        11202 :         WriteRqst.Write = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
    3021        11202 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3022        11202 :         flexible = false;       /* ensure it all gets written */
    3023              :     }
    3024              : 
    3025              :     /*
    3026              :      * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
    3027              :      * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
    3028              :      * preventing the file from being deleted.
    3029              :      */
    3030        15268 :     if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3031              :     {
    3032        10422 :         if (openLogFile >= 0)
    3033              :         {
    3034         7086 :             if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    3035              :                                  wal_segment_size))
    3036              :             {
    3037          151 :                 XLogFileClose();
    3038              :             }
    3039              :         }
    3040        10422 :         return false;
    3041              :     }
    3042              : 
    3043              :     /*
    3044              :      * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
    3045              :      * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
    3046              :      *
    3047              :      * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
    3048              :      * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up.  Make sure the
    3049              :      * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
    3050              :      */
    3051         4846 :     now = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    3052         4846 :     flushblocks =
    3053         4846 :         WriteRqst.Write / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    3054              : 
    3055         4846 :     if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
    3056              :     {
    3057              :         /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
    3058          280 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3059          280 :         lastflush = now;
    3060              :     }
    3061         4566 :     else if (TimestampDifferenceExceeds(lastflush, now, WalWriterDelay))
    3062              :     {
    3063              :         /*
    3064              :          * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
    3065              :          * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
    3066              :          * commit to hit disk.
    3067              :          */
    3068         4411 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3069         4411 :         lastflush = now;
    3070              :     }
    3071          155 :     else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
    3072              :     {
    3073              :         /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
    3074          142 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3075          142 :         lastflush = now;
    3076              :     }
    3077              :     else
    3078              :     {
    3079              :         /* no flushing, this time round */
    3080           13 :         WriteRqst.Flush = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    3081              :     }
    3082              : 
    3083              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    3084              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    3085              :         elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
    3086              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Write),
    3087              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Flush),
    3088              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    3089              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    3090              : #endif
    3091              : 
    3092         4846 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    3093              : 
    3094              :     /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
    3095         4846 :     WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst.Write);
    3096         4846 :     LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    3097         4846 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3098         4846 :     if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
    3099          347 :         WriteRqst.Flush > LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3100              :     {
    3101         4685 :         XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, flexible);
    3102              :     }
    3103         4846 :     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    3104              : 
    3105         4846 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    3106              : 
    3107              :     /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
    3108         4846 :     WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(true, !RecoveryInProgress());
    3109              : 
    3110              :     /*
    3111              :      * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
    3112              :      */
    3113         9692 :     if (waitLSNState &&
    3114         4846 :         (LogwrtResult.Flush >=
    3115         4846 :          pg_atomic_read_u64(&waitLSNState->minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH])))
    3116            0 :         WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    3117              : 
    3118              :     /*
    3119              :      * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
    3120              :      * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
    3121              :      */
    3122         4846 :     AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(InvalidXLogRecPtr, insertTLI, true);
    3123              : 
    3124              :     /*
    3125              :      * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
    3126              :      * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
    3127              :      * avoid hibernating too early.
    3128              :      */
    3129         4846 :     return true;
    3130              : }
    3131              : 
    3132              : /*
    3133              :  * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given
    3134              :  * position, or whether the minimum recovery point has been updated past
    3135              :  * the given position.
    3136              :  *
    3137              :  * Returns true if a flush is still needed, or if the minimum recovery point
    3138              :  * must be updated.
    3139              :  *
    3140              :  * It is possible that someone else is already in the process of flushing
    3141              :  * that far, or has updated the minimum recovery point up to the given
    3142              :  * position.
    3143              :  */
    3144              : bool
    3145      8806677 : XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
    3146              : {
    3147              :     /*
    3148              :      * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
    3149              :      * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
    3150              :      * would need to be updated.
    3151              :      *
    3152              :      * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
    3153              :      * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
    3154              :      * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
    3155              :      */
    3156      8806677 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
    3157              :     {
    3158              :         /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
    3159       592450 :         if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || record <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint)
    3160       581939 :             return false;
    3161              : 
    3162              :         /*
    3163              :          * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
    3164              :          * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery.  We never modify the control
    3165              :          * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
    3166              :          * here too.  This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
    3167              :          * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
    3168              :          * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
    3169              :          */
    3170        10511 :         if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
    3171              :         {
    3172            0 :             updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    3173            0 :             return false;
    3174              :         }
    3175              : 
    3176              :         /*
    3177              :          * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
    3178              :          * just return a conservative guess.
    3179              :          */
    3180        10511 :         if (!LWLockConditionalAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED))
    3181            0 :             return true;
    3182        10511 :         LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    3183        10511 :         LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    3184        10511 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3185              : 
    3186              :         /*
    3187              :          * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
    3188              :          * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
    3189              :          * file value if crash recovery is still running.
    3190              :          */
    3191        10511 :         if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    3192            0 :             updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    3193              : 
    3194              :         /* check again */
    3195        10511 :         if (record <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint)
    3196           91 :             return false;
    3197              :         else
    3198        10420 :             return true;
    3199              :     }
    3200              : 
    3201              :     /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
    3202      8214227 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3203      7957929 :         return false;
    3204              : 
    3205              :     /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
    3206       256298 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3207              : 
    3208              :     /* check again */
    3209       256298 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3210         3485 :         return false;
    3211              : 
    3212       252813 :     return true;
    3213              : }
    3214              : 
    3215              : /*
    3216              :  * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
    3217              :  *
    3218              :  * logsegno: identify segment.
    3219              :  *
    3220              :  * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
    3221              :  *
    3222              :  * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
    3223              :  *
    3224              :  * Returns -1 or FD of opened file.  A -1 here is not an error; a caller
    3225              :  * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
    3226              :  * succeed.  (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
    3227              :  */
    3228              : static int
    3229        14949 : XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli,
    3230              :                      bool *added, char *path)
    3231              : {
    3232              :     char        tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
    3233              :     XLogSegNo   installed_segno;
    3234              :     XLogSegNo   max_segno;
    3235              :     int         fd;
    3236              :     int         save_errno;
    3237        14949 :     int         open_flags = O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY;
    3238              :     instr_time  io_start;
    3239              : 
    3240              :     Assert(logtli != 0);
    3241              : 
    3242        14949 :     XLogFilePath(path, logtli, logsegno, wal_segment_size);
    3243              : 
    3244              :     /*
    3245              :      * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
    3246              :      */
    3247        14949 :     *added = false;
    3248        14949 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3249        14949 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3250        14949 :     if (fd < 0)
    3251              :     {
    3252         1472 :         if (errno != ENOENT)
    3253            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3254              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3255              :                      errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3256              :     }
    3257              :     else
    3258        13477 :         return fd;
    3259              : 
    3260              :     /*
    3261              :      * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment.  NOTE: it is possible that
    3262              :      * another process is doing the same thing.  If so, we will end up
    3263              :      * pre-creating an extra log segment.  That seems OK, and better than
    3264              :      * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
    3265              :      */
    3266         1472 :     elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
    3267              : 
    3268         1472 :     snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
    3269              : 
    3270         1472 :     unlink(tmppath);
    3271              : 
    3272         1472 :     if (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT)
    3273            0 :         open_flags |= PG_O_DIRECT;
    3274              : 
    3275              :     /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
    3276         1472 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(tmppath, open_flags);
    3277         1472 :     if (fd < 0)
    3278            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3279              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3280              :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3281              : 
    3282              :     /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
    3283         1472 :     io_start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    3284              : 
    3285         1472 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_WRITE);
    3286         1472 :     save_errno = 0;
    3287         1472 :     if (wal_init_zero)
    3288              :     {
    3289              :         ssize_t     rc;
    3290              : 
    3291              :         /*
    3292              :          * Zero-fill the file.  With this setting, we do this the hard way to
    3293              :          * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated.  On
    3294              :          * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
    3295              :          * doesn't allocate intermediate space.  This way, we know that we
    3296              :          * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
    3297              :          * indirect blocks are down on disk.  Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
    3298              :          * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
    3299              :          */
    3300         1472 :         rc = pg_pwrite_zeros(fd, wal_segment_size, 0);
    3301              : 
    3302         1472 :         if (rc < 0)
    3303            0 :             save_errno = errno;
    3304              :     }
    3305              :     else
    3306              :     {
    3307              :         /*
    3308              :          * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
    3309              :          * enough.
    3310              :          */
    3311            0 :         errno = 0;
    3312            0 :         if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
    3313              :         {
    3314              :             /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
    3315            0 :             save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC;
    3316              :         }
    3317              :     }
    3318         1472 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3319              : 
    3320              :     /*
    3321              :      * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
    3322              :      * byte is written when not using it.
    3323              :      */
    3324         1472 :     pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_INIT, IOOP_WRITE,
    3325              :                             io_start, 1,
    3326         1472 :                             wal_init_zero ? wal_segment_size : 1);
    3327              : 
    3328         1472 :     if (save_errno)
    3329              :     {
    3330              :         /*
    3331              :          * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
    3332              :          */
    3333            0 :         unlink(tmppath);
    3334              : 
    3335            0 :         close(fd);
    3336              : 
    3337            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3338              : 
    3339            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3340              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3341              :                  errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3342              :     }
    3343              : 
    3344              :     /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
    3345         1472 :     io_start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    3346              : 
    3347         1472 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_SYNC);
    3348         1472 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    3349              :     {
    3350            0 :         save_errno = errno;
    3351            0 :         close(fd);
    3352            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3353            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3354              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3355              :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3356              :     }
    3357         1472 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3358              : 
    3359         1472 :     pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_INIT,
    3360              :                             IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
    3361              : 
    3362         1472 :     if (close(fd) != 0)
    3363            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3364              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3365              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3366              : 
    3367              :     /*
    3368              :      * Now move the segment into place with its final name.  Cope with
    3369              :      * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
    3370              :      * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
    3371              :      */
    3372         1472 :     installed_segno = logsegno;
    3373              : 
    3374              :     /*
    3375              :      * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
    3376              :      * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
    3377              :      * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
    3378              :      * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
    3379              :      * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
    3380              :      * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
    3381              :      * CheckPointSegments.
    3382              :      */
    3383         1472 :     max_segno = logsegno + CheckPointSegments;
    3384         1472 :     if (InstallXLogFileSegment(&installed_segno, tmppath, true, max_segno,
    3385              :                                logtli))
    3386              :     {
    3387         1472 :         *added = true;
    3388         1472 :         elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
    3389              :     }
    3390              :     else
    3391              :     {
    3392              :         /*
    3393              :          * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
    3394              :          * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
    3395              :          * caller opening the file may fail.
    3396              :          */
    3397            0 :         unlink(tmppath);
    3398            0 :         elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
    3399              :     }
    3400              : 
    3401         1472 :     return -1;
    3402              : }
    3403              : 
    3404              : /*
    3405              :  * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
    3406              :  *
    3407              :  * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
    3408              :  *
    3409              :  * Returns FD of opened file.
    3410              :  *
    3411              :  * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
    3412              :  * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
    3413              :  * take down the system on failure).  They will promote to PANIC if we are
    3414              :  * in a critical section.
    3415              :  */
    3416              : int
    3417        14722 : XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
    3418              : {
    3419              :     bool        ignore_added;
    3420              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3421              :     int         fd;
    3422              : 
    3423              :     Assert(logtli != 0);
    3424              : 
    3425        14722 :     fd = XLogFileInitInternal(logsegno, logtli, &ignore_added, path);
    3426        14722 :     if (fd >= 0)
    3427        13354 :         return fd;
    3428              : 
    3429              :     /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
    3430         1368 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3431         1368 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3432         1368 :     if (fd < 0)
    3433            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3434              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3435              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3436         1368 :     return fd;
    3437              : }
    3438              : 
    3439              : /*
    3440              :  * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
    3441              :  *
    3442              :  * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
    3443              :  *
    3444              :  * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
    3445              :  *      a different timeline)
    3446              :  *
    3447              :  * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
    3448              :  *      zeros)
    3449              :  *
    3450              :  * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
    3451              :  * considerations.  But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
    3452              :  * emplacing a bogus file.
    3453              :  */
    3454              : static void
    3455           44 : XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno,
    3456              :              TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno,
    3457              :              int upto)
    3458              : {
    3459              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3460              :     char        tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
    3461              :     PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
    3462              :     int         srcfd;
    3463              :     int         fd;
    3464              :     int         nbytes;
    3465              : 
    3466              :     /*
    3467              :      * Open the source file
    3468              :      */
    3469           44 :     XLogFilePath(path, srcTLI, srcsegno, wal_segment_size);
    3470           44 :     srcfd = OpenTransientFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY);
    3471           44 :     if (srcfd < 0)
    3472            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3473              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3474              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3475              : 
    3476              :     /*
    3477              :      * Copy into a temp file name.
    3478              :      */
    3479           44 :     snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
    3480              : 
    3481           44 :     unlink(tmppath);
    3482              : 
    3483              :     /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
    3484           44 :     fd = OpenTransientFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
    3485           44 :     if (fd < 0)
    3486            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3487              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3488              :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3489              : 
    3490              :     /*
    3491              :      * Do the data copying.
    3492              :      */
    3493        90156 :     for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
    3494              :     {
    3495              :         int         nread;
    3496              : 
    3497        90112 :         nread = upto - nbytes;
    3498              : 
    3499              :         /*
    3500              :          * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
    3501              :          * zeros.
    3502              :          */
    3503        90112 :         if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
    3504           44 :             memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
    3505              : 
    3506        90112 :         if (nread > 0)
    3507              :         {
    3508              :             int         r;
    3509              : 
    3510         2742 :             if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
    3511         2698 :                 nread = sizeof(buffer);
    3512         2742 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_READ);
    3513         2742 :             r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
    3514         2742 :             if (r != nread)
    3515              :             {
    3516            0 :                 if (r < 0)
    3517            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3518              :                             (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3519              :                              errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
    3520              :                                     path)));
    3521              :                 else
    3522            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3523              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    3524              :                              errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
    3525              :                                     path, r, (Size) nread)));
    3526              :             }
    3527         2742 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3528              :         }
    3529        90112 :         errno = 0;
    3530        90112 :         pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_WRITE);
    3531        90112 :         if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
    3532              :         {
    3533            0 :             int         save_errno = errno;
    3534              : 
    3535              :             /*
    3536              :              * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
    3537              :              */
    3538            0 :             unlink(tmppath);
    3539              :             /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    3540            0 :             errno = save_errno ? save_errno : ENOSPC;
    3541              : 
    3542            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3543              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3544              :                      errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3545              :         }
    3546        90112 :         pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3547              :     }
    3548              : 
    3549           44 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_SYNC);
    3550           44 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    3551            0 :         ereport(data_sync_elevel(ERROR),
    3552              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3553              :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3554           44 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3555              : 
    3556           44 :     if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
    3557            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3558              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3559              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3560              : 
    3561           44 :     if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
    3562            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3563              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3564              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3565              : 
    3566              :     /*
    3567              :      * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
    3568              :      */
    3569           44 :     if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&destsegno, tmppath, false, 0, destTLI))
    3570            0 :         elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
    3571           44 : }
    3572              : 
    3573              : /*
    3574              :  * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
    3575              :  *
    3576              :  * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
    3577              :  * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
    3578              :  *
    3579              :  * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
    3580              :  * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
    3581              :  * actual installation location or last segment searched.
    3582              :  *
    3583              :  * tmppath: initial name of file to install.  It will be renamed into place.
    3584              :  *
    3585              :  * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
    3586              :  * number at or after the passed numbers.  If false, install the new segment
    3587              :  * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
    3588              :  *
    3589              :  * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as.  Fail if no
    3590              :  * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
    3591              :  * is false.)
    3592              :  *
    3593              :  * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
    3594              :  *
    3595              :  * Returns true if the file was installed successfully.  false indicates that
    3596              :  * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
    3597              :  * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
    3598              :  */
    3599              : static bool
    3600         2944 : InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
    3601              :                        bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3602              : {
    3603              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3604              :     struct stat stat_buf;
    3605              : 
    3606              :     Assert(tli != 0);
    3607              : 
    3608         2944 :     XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
    3609              : 
    3610         2944 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    3611         2944 :     if (!XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive)
    3612              :     {
    3613            0 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3614            0 :         return false;
    3615              :     }
    3616              : 
    3617         2944 :     if (!find_free)
    3618              :     {
    3619              :         /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
    3620           44 :         durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
    3621              :     }
    3622              :     else
    3623              :     {
    3624              :         /* Find a free slot to put it in */
    3625         4268 :         while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    3626              :         {
    3627         1414 :             if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
    3628              :             {
    3629              :                 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
    3630           46 :                 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3631           46 :                 return false;
    3632              :             }
    3633         1368 :             (*segno)++;
    3634         1368 :             XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
    3635              :         }
    3636              :     }
    3637              : 
    3638              :     Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
    3639         2898 :     if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
    3640              :     {
    3641            0 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3642              :         /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
    3643            0 :         return false;
    3644              :     }
    3645              : 
    3646         2898 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3647              : 
    3648         2898 :     return true;
    3649              : }
    3650              : 
    3651              : /*
    3652              :  * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
    3653              :  */
    3654              : int
    3655          222 : XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3656              : {
    3657              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3658              :     int         fd;
    3659              : 
    3660          222 :     XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3661              : 
    3662          222 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3663          222 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3664          222 :     if (fd < 0)
    3665            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    3666              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3667              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3668              : 
    3669          222 :     return fd;
    3670              : }
    3671              : 
    3672              : /*
    3673              :  * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
    3674              :  */
    3675              : static void
    3676         6528 : XLogFileClose(void)
    3677              : {
    3678              :     Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
    3679              : 
    3680              :     /*
    3681              :      * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
    3682              :      * the OS to release any cached pages.  But do not do so if WAL archiving
    3683              :      * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
    3684              :      * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
    3685              :      */
    3686              : #if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
    3687         6528 :     if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
    3688          125 :         (void) posix_fadvise(openLogFile, 0, 0, POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED);
    3689              : #endif
    3690              : 
    3691         6528 :     if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
    3692              :     {
    3693              :         char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3694            0 :         int         save_errno = errno;
    3695              : 
    3696            0 :         XLogFileName(xlogfname, openLogTLI, openLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3697            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3698            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    3699              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3700              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    3701              :     }
    3702              : 
    3703         6528 :     openLogFile = -1;
    3704         6528 :     ReleaseExternalFD();
    3705         6528 : }
    3706              : 
    3707              : /*
    3708              :  * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
    3709              :  *
    3710              :  * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
    3711              :  * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
    3712              :  * the current one.  This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
    3713              :  * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
    3714              :  * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
    3715              :  * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
    3716              :  *
    3717              :  * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR).  All known causes indicate big
    3718              :  * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause.  The checkpoint WAL
    3719              :  * and/or ControlFile updates already completed.  If a RequestCheckpoint()
    3720              :  * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
    3721              :  * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails.  That's not ideal, but it's
    3722              :  * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
    3723              :  * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
    3724              :  * reporting and resource reclamation.)
    3725              :  */
    3726              : static void
    3727         2070 : PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
    3728              : {
    3729              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    3730              :     int         lf;
    3731              :     bool        added;
    3732              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3733              :     uint64      offset;
    3734              : 
    3735         2070 :     if (!XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive)
    3736           11 :         return;                 /* unlocked check says no */
    3737              : 
    3738         2059 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(endptr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3739         2059 :     offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
    3740         2059 :     if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
    3741              :     {
    3742          227 :         _logSegNo++;
    3743          227 :         lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
    3744          227 :         if (lf >= 0)
    3745          123 :             close(lf);
    3746          227 :         if (added)
    3747          104 :             CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added++;
    3748              :     }
    3749              : }
    3750              : 
    3751              : /*
    3752              :  * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
    3753              :  * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
    3754              :  * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
    3755              :  * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
    3756              :  * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
    3757              :  *
    3758              :  * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
    3759              :  * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
    3760              :  * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
    3761              :  * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
    3762              :  */
    3763              : void
    3764       116811 : CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3765              : {
    3766       116811 :     int         save_errno = errno;
    3767              :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;
    3768              : 
    3769       116811 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3770       116811 :     lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
    3771       116811 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3772              : 
    3773       116811 :     if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
    3774              :     {
    3775              :         char        filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3776              : 
    3777            0 :         XLogFileName(filename, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3778            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3779            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3780              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3781              :                  errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
    3782              :                         filename)));
    3783              :     }
    3784       116811 :     errno = save_errno;
    3785       116811 : }
    3786              : 
    3787              : /*
    3788              :  * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
    3789              :  * since startup.
    3790              :  *
    3791              :  * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
    3792              :  * with that.
    3793              :  */
    3794              : XLogSegNo
    3795         1253 : XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
    3796              : {
    3797              :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;
    3798              : 
    3799         1253 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3800         1253 :     lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
    3801         1253 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3802              : 
    3803         1253 :     return lastRemovedSegNo;
    3804              : }
    3805              : 
    3806              : /*
    3807              :  * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
    3808              :  * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
    3809              :  */
    3810              : XLogSegNo
    3811            7 : XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
    3812              : {
    3813              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3814              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3815            7 :     XLogSegNo   oldest_segno = 0;
    3816              : 
    3817            7 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3818           50 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3819              :     {
    3820              :         TimeLineID  file_tli;
    3821              :         XLogSegNo   file_segno;
    3822              : 
    3823              :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
    3824           43 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3825           29 :             continue;
    3826              : 
    3827              :         /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
    3828           14 :         XLogFromFileName(xlde->d_name, &file_tli, &file_segno,
    3829              :                          wal_segment_size);
    3830              : 
    3831              :         /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
    3832           14 :         if (tli != file_tli)
    3833            0 :             continue;
    3834              : 
    3835              :         /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
    3836           14 :         if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
    3837            8 :             oldest_segno = file_segno;
    3838              :     }
    3839              : 
    3840            7 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3841            7 :     return oldest_segno;
    3842              : }
    3843              : 
    3844              : /*
    3845              :  * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
    3846              :  * given XLOG file has been removed.
    3847              :  */
    3848              : static void
    3849         2576 : UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
    3850              : {
    3851              :     uint32      tli;
    3852              :     XLogSegNo   segno;
    3853              : 
    3854         2576 :     XLogFromFileName(filename, &tli, &segno, wal_segment_size);
    3855              : 
    3856         2576 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3857         2576 :     if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
    3858         1159 :         XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
    3859         2576 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3860         2576 : }
    3861              : 
    3862              : /*
    3863              :  * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
    3864              :  *
    3865              :  * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
    3866              :  * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
    3867              :  */
    3868              : static void
    3869          185 : RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
    3870              : {
    3871              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3872              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3873              : 
    3874          185 :     elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
    3875              : 
    3876          185 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3877         1253 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3878              :     {
    3879              :         char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3880              : 
    3881         1068 :         if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
    3882         1068 :             continue;
    3883              : 
    3884            0 :         snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
    3885            0 :         unlink(path);
    3886            0 :         elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
    3887              :     }
    3888          185 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3889          185 : }
    3890              : 
    3891              : /*
    3892              :  * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
    3893              :  *
    3894              :  * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
    3895              :  * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
    3896              :  * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
    3897              :  *
    3898              :  * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
    3899              :  * segments should be reused for this timeline.
    3900              :  */
    3901              : static void
    3902         1796 : RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr,
    3903              :                    TimeLineID insertTLI)
    3904              : {
    3905              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3906              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3907              :     char        lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3908              :     XLogSegNo   endlogSegNo;
    3909              :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    3910              : 
    3911              :     /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
    3912         1796 :     XLByteToSeg(endptr, endlogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3913         1796 :     recycleSegNo = XLOGfileslop(lastredoptr);
    3914              : 
    3915              :     /*
    3916              :      * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
    3917              :      * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
    3918              :      * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
    3919              :      */
    3920         1796 :     XLogFileName(lastoff, 0, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3921              : 
    3922         1796 :     elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
    3923              :          lastoff);
    3924              : 
    3925         1796 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3926              : 
    3927        35077 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3928              :     {
    3929              :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
    3930        33281 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
    3931         7691 :             !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3932         7689 :             continue;
    3933              : 
    3934              :         /*
    3935              :          * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
    3936              :          * deciding whether a segment is still needed.  This ensures that we
    3937              :          * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
    3938              :          * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
    3939              :          * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
    3940              :          * complicated.
    3941              :          *
    3942              :          * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
    3943              :          * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
    3944              :          */
    3945        25592 :         if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
    3946              :         {
    3947        18391 :             if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
    3948              :             {
    3949              :                 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
    3950         2576 :                 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
    3951              : 
    3952         2576 :                 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endlogSegNo, insertTLI);
    3953              :             }
    3954              :         }
    3955              :     }
    3956              : 
    3957         1796 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3958         1796 : }
    3959              : 
    3960              : /*
    3961              :  * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
    3962              :  * history.
    3963              :  *
    3964              :  * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
    3965              :  * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
    3966              :  * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
    3967              :  * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
    3968              :  * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
    3969              :  * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
    3970              :  * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
    3971              :  * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
    3972              :  *
    3973              :  * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
    3974              :  * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
    3975              :  */
    3976              : void
    3977           66 : RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
    3978              : {
    3979              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3980              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3981              :     char        switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3982              :     XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    3983              :     XLogSegNo   switchLogSegNo;
    3984              :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    3985              : 
    3986              :     /*
    3987              :      * Initialize info about where to begin the work.  This will recycle,
    3988              :      * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
    3989              :      */
    3990           66 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(switchpoint, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3991           66 :     XLByteToSeg(switchpoint, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3992           66 :     recycleSegNo = endLogSegNo + 10;
    3993              : 
    3994              :     /*
    3995              :      * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
    3996              :      */
    3997           66 :     XLogFileName(switchseg, newTLI, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3998              : 
    3999           66 :     elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
    4000              :          switchseg);
    4001              : 
    4002           66 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    4003              : 
    4004          627 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    4005              :     {
    4006              :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
    4007          561 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    4008          348 :             continue;
    4009              : 
    4010              :         /*
    4011              :          * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
    4012              :          * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
    4013              :          * new timeline.
    4014              :          */
    4015          213 :         if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
    4016          139 :             strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
    4017              :         {
    4018              :             /*
    4019              :              * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
    4020              :              * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
    4021              :              * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
    4022              :              * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
    4023              :              */
    4024           16 :             if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
    4025           16 :                 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endLogSegNo, newTLI);
    4026              :         }
    4027              :     }
    4028              : 
    4029           66 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    4030           66 : }
    4031              : 
    4032              : /*
    4033              :  * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
    4034              :  *
    4035              :  * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
    4036              :  * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to.  endlogSegNo is
    4037              :  * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
    4038              :  *
    4039              :  * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
    4040              :  * checked again with future callers of this function.
    4041              :  *
    4042              :  * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
    4043              :  * should be used for this timeline.
    4044              :  */
    4045              : static void
    4046         2592 : RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
    4047              :                XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo,
    4048              :                TimeLineID insertTLI)
    4049              : {
    4050              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    4051              : #ifdef WIN32
    4052              :     char        newpath[MAXPGPATH];
    4053              : #endif
    4054         2592 :     const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
    4055              : 
    4056         2592 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
    4057              : 
    4058              :     /*
    4059              :      * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
    4060              :      * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
    4061              :      * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
    4062              :      */
    4063         2592 :     if (wal_recycle &&
    4064         2592 :         *endlogSegNo <= recycleSegNo &&
    4065         3183 :         XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
    4066         2856 :         get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
    4067         1428 :         InstallXLogFileSegment(endlogSegNo, path,
    4068              :                                true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
    4069              :     {
    4070         1382 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    4071              :                 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
    4072              :                                  segname)));
    4073         1382 :         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled++;
    4074              :         /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
    4075         1382 :         (*endlogSegNo)++;
    4076              :     }
    4077              :     else
    4078              :     {
    4079              :         /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
    4080              :         int         rc;
    4081              : 
    4082         1210 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    4083              :                 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
    4084              :                                  segname)));
    4085              : 
    4086              : #ifdef WIN32
    4087              : 
    4088              :         /*
    4089              :          * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
    4090              :          * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
    4091              :          * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
    4092              :          * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
    4093              :          * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
    4094              :          *
    4095              :          * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
    4096              :          * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
    4097              :          */
    4098              :         snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
    4099              :         if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
    4100              :         {
    4101              :             ereport(LOG,
    4102              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4103              :                      errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
    4104              :                             path)));
    4105              :             return;
    4106              :         }
    4107              :         rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
    4108              : #else
    4109         1210 :         rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
    4110              : #endif
    4111         1210 :         if (rc != 0)
    4112              :         {
    4113              :             /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
    4114            0 :             return;
    4115              :         }
    4116         1210 :         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed++;
    4117              :     }
    4118              : 
    4119         2592 :     XLogArchiveCleanup(segname);
    4120              : }
    4121              : 
    4122              : /*
    4123              :  * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
    4124              :  * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
    4125              :  *
    4126              :  * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
    4127              :  * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
    4128              :  * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
    4129              :  *
    4130              :  * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
    4131              :  * policy decision was made not to.  It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
    4132              :  * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
    4133              :  * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
    4134              :  */
    4135              : static void
    4136         1004 : ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
    4137              : {
    4138              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    4139              :     struct stat stat_buf;
    4140              : 
    4141              :     /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
    4142         1004 :     if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
    4143         1004 :         !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4144            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4145              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4146              :                  errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4147              :                         XLOGDIR)));
    4148              : 
    4149              :     /* Check for archive_status */
    4150         1004 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
    4151         1004 :     if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    4152              :     {
    4153              :         /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
    4154         1003 :         if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4155            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4156              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4157              :                      errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4158              :                             path)));
    4159              :     }
    4160              :     else
    4161              :     {
    4162            1 :         ereport(LOG,
    4163              :                 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
    4164            1 :         if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
    4165            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4166              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4167              :                      errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
    4168              :                             path)));
    4169              :     }
    4170              : 
    4171              :     /* Check for summaries */
    4172         1004 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
    4173         1004 :     if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    4174              :     {
    4175              :         /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
    4176         1003 :         if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4177            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4178              :                     (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4179              :                             path)));
    4180              :     }
    4181              :     else
    4182              :     {
    4183            1 :         ereport(LOG,
    4184              :                 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
    4185            1 :         if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
    4186            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4187              :                     (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
    4188              :                             path)));
    4189              :     }
    4190         1004 : }
    4191              : 
    4192              : /*
    4193              :  * Remove previous backup history files.  This also retries creation of
    4194              :  * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
    4195              :  * failed earlier.
    4196              :  */
    4197              : static void
    4198          156 : CleanupBackupHistory(void)
    4199              : {
    4200              :     DIR        *xldir;
    4201              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    4202              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
    4203              : 
    4204          156 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    4205              : 
    4206         1607 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    4207              :     {
    4208         1295 :         if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
    4209              :         {
    4210          165 :             if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
    4211              :             {
    4212          130 :                 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
    4213              :                      xlde->d_name);
    4214          130 :                 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
    4215          130 :                 unlink(path);
    4216          130 :                 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
    4217              :             }
    4218              :         }
    4219              :     }
    4220              : 
    4221          156 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    4222          156 : }
    4223              : 
    4224              : /*
    4225              :  * I/O routines for pg_control
    4226              :  *
    4227              :  * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
    4228              :  * contents of pg_control.  WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
    4229              :  * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
    4230              :  * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
    4231              :  * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
    4232              :  * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
    4233              :  *
    4234              :  * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
    4235              :  * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
    4236              :  * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct.  We could split out the
    4237              :  * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
    4238              :  */
    4239              : 
    4240              : static void
    4241           51 : InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
    4242              : {
    4243              :     char        mock_auth_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN];
    4244              : 
    4245              :     /*
    4246              :      * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
    4247              :      * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
    4248              :      * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
    4249              :      * of an actual stored password.
    4250              :      */
    4251           51 :     if (!pg_strong_random(mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN))
    4252            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4253              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR),
    4254              :                  errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
    4255              : 
    4256           51 :     memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4257              :     /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
    4258           51 :     ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
    4259           51 :     memcpy(ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce, mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN);
    4260           51 :     ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
    4261           51 :     ControlFile->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN;
    4262              : 
    4263              :     /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
    4264           51 :     ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    4265           51 :     ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    4266           51 :     ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    4267           51 :     ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    4268           51 :     ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    4269           51 :     ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
    4270           51 :     ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    4271           51 :     ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    4272           51 :     ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
    4273           51 : }
    4274              : 
    4275              : static void
    4276           51 : WriteControlFile(void)
    4277              : {
    4278              :     int         fd;
    4279              :     char        buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE];   /* need not be aligned */
    4280              : 
    4281              :     /*
    4282              :      * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
    4283              :      */
    4284           51 :     ControlFile->pg_control_version = PG_CONTROL_VERSION;
    4285           51 :     ControlFile->catalog_version_no = CATALOG_VERSION_NO;
    4286              : 
    4287           51 :     ControlFile->maxAlign = MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF;
    4288           51 :     ControlFile->floatFormat = FLOATFORMAT_VALUE;
    4289              : 
    4290           51 :     ControlFile->blcksz = BLCKSZ;
    4291           51 :     ControlFile->relseg_size = RELSEG_SIZE;
    4292           51 :     ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment = SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT;
    4293           51 :     ControlFile->xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    4294           51 :     ControlFile->xlog_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    4295              : 
    4296           51 :     ControlFile->nameDataLen = NAMEDATALEN;
    4297           51 :     ControlFile->indexMaxKeys = INDEX_MAX_KEYS;
    4298              : 
    4299           51 :     ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size = TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE;
    4300           51 :     ControlFile->loblksize = LOBLKSIZE;
    4301              : 
    4302           51 :     ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
    4303              : 
    4304              :     /*
    4305              :      * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
    4306              :      *
    4307              :      * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
    4308              :      * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
    4309              :      * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
    4310              :      * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
    4311              :      * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
    4312              :      * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
    4313              :      * platforms.
    4314              :      *
    4315              :      * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
    4316              :      * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
    4317              :      * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
    4318              :      *
    4319              :      * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
    4320              :      * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
    4321              :      * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
    4322              :      * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
    4323              :      * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
    4324              :      * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
    4325              :      * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
    4326              :      * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
    4327              :      * retrospective ideal.
    4328              :      */
    4329           51 :     ControlFile->default_char_signedness = true;
    4330              : 
    4331              :     /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
    4332           51 :     INIT_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
    4333           51 :     COMP_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc,
    4334              :                 ControlFile,
    4335              :                 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
    4336           51 :     FIN_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
    4337              : 
    4338              :     /*
    4339              :      * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
    4340              :      * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData).  This reduces the odds of
    4341              :      * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control.  We'll still fail when we
    4342              :      * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
    4343              :      * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
    4344              :      */
    4345           51 :     memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
    4346           51 :     memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4347              : 
    4348           51 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
    4349              :                        O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
    4350           51 :     if (fd < 0)
    4351            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4352              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4353              :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
    4354              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4355              : 
    4356           51 :     errno = 0;
    4357           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_WRITE);
    4358           51 :     if (write(fd, buffer, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE) != PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE)
    4359              :     {
    4360              :         /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    4361            0 :         if (errno == 0)
    4362            0 :             errno = ENOSPC;
    4363            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4364              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4365              :                  errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
    4366              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4367              :     }
    4368           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4369              : 
    4370           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_SYNC);
    4371           51 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    4372            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4373              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4374              :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
    4375              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4376           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4377              : 
    4378           51 :     if (close(fd) != 0)
    4379            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4380              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4381              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
    4382              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4383           51 : }
    4384              : 
    4385              : static void
    4386         1056 : ReadControlFile(void)
    4387              : {
    4388              :     pg_crc32c   crc;
    4389              :     int         fd;
    4390              :     char        wal_segsz_str[20];
    4391              :     int         r;
    4392              : 
    4393              :     /*
    4394              :      * Read data...
    4395              :      */
    4396         1056 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
    4397              :                        O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
    4398         1056 :     if (fd < 0)
    4399            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4400              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4401              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
    4402              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4403              : 
    4404         1056 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_READ);
    4405         1056 :     r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4406         1056 :     if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
    4407              :     {
    4408            0 :         if (r < 0)
    4409            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    4410              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4411              :                      errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
    4412              :                             XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4413              :         else
    4414            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    4415              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    4416              :                      errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
    4417              :                             XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
    4418              :     }
    4419         1056 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4420              : 
    4421         1056 :     close(fd);
    4422              : 
    4423              :     /*
    4424              :      * Check for expected pg_control format version.  If this is wrong, the
    4425              :      * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
    4426              :      * of bytes.  Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
    4427              :      * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
    4428              :      */
    4429              : 
    4430         1056 :     if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION && ControlFile->pg_control_version % 65536 == 0 && ControlFile->pg_control_version / 65536 != 0)
    4431            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4432              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4433              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4434              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
    4435              :                            " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
    4436              :                            ControlFile->pg_control_version, ControlFile->pg_control_version,
    4437              :                            PG_CONTROL_VERSION, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
    4438              :                  errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering.  It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4439              : 
    4440         1056 :     if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION)
    4441            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4442              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4443              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4444              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
    4445              :                            " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
    4446              :                            ControlFile->pg_control_version, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
    4447              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4448              : 
    4449              :     /* Now check the CRC. */
    4450         1056 :     INIT_CRC32C(crc);
    4451         1056 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc,
    4452              :                 ControlFile,
    4453              :                 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
    4454         1056 :     FIN_CRC32C(crc);
    4455              : 
    4456         1056 :     if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
    4457            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4458              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4459              :                  errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
    4460              : 
    4461              :     /*
    4462              :      * Do compatibility checking immediately.  If the database isn't
    4463              :      * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
    4464              :      * possibly do any damage.
    4465              :      */
    4466         1056 :     if (ControlFile->catalog_version_no != CATALOG_VERSION_NO)
    4467            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4468              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4469              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4470              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4471              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4472              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4473              :                            "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
    4474              :                            "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
    4475              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4476         1056 :     if (ControlFile->maxAlign != MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF)
    4477            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4478              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4479              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4480              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4481              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4482              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4483              :                            "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
    4484              :                            "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
    4485              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4486         1056 :     if (ControlFile->floatFormat != FLOATFORMAT_VALUE)
    4487            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4488              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4489              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4490              :                  errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
    4491              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4492         1056 :     if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
    4493            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4494              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4495              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4496              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4497              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4498              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4499              :                            "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
    4500              :                            "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
    4501              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4502         1056 :     if (ControlFile->relseg_size != RELSEG_SIZE)
    4503            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4504              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4505              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4506              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4507              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4508              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4509              :                            "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
    4510              :                            "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
    4511              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4512         1056 :     if (ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment != SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT)
    4513            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4514              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4515              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4516              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4517              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4518              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4519              :                            "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
    4520              :                            "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
    4521              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4522         1056 :     if (ControlFile->xlog_blcksz != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    4523            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4524              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4525              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4526              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4527              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4528              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4529              :                            "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
    4530              :                            "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
    4531              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4532         1056 :     if (ControlFile->nameDataLen != NAMEDATALEN)
    4533            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4534              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4535              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4536              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4537              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4538              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4539              :                            "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
    4540              :                            "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
    4541              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4542         1056 :     if (ControlFile->indexMaxKeys != INDEX_MAX_KEYS)
    4543            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4544              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4545              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4546              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4547              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4548              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4549              :                            "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
    4550              :                            "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
    4551              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4552         1056 :     if (ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size != TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE)
    4553            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4554              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4555              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4556              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4557              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4558              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4559              :                            "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
    4560              :                            "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
    4561              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4562         1056 :     if (ControlFile->loblksize != LOBLKSIZE)
    4563            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4564              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4565              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4566              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4567              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4568              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4569              :                            "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
    4570              :                            "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
    4571              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4572              : 
    4573              :     Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal);    /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
    4574              : 
    4575         1056 :     wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size;
    4576              : 
    4577         1056 :     if (!IsValidWalSegSize(wal_segment_size))
    4578            0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4579              :                         errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
    4580              :                                       "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
    4581              :                                       wal_segment_size,
    4582              :                                       wal_segment_size),
    4583              :                         errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
    4584              : 
    4585         1056 :     snprintf(wal_segsz_str, sizeof(wal_segsz_str), "%d", wal_segment_size);
    4586         1056 :     SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
    4587              :                     PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4588              : 
    4589              :     /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
    4590         1056 :     if (ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
    4591            0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4592              :         /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
    4593              :                         errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
    4594              :                                "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
    4595              : 
    4596         1056 :     if (ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
    4597            0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4598              :         /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
    4599              :                         errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
    4600              :                                "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
    4601              : 
    4602         1056 :     UsableBytesInSegment =
    4603         1056 :         (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ * UsableBytesInPage) -
    4604              :         (SizeOfXLogLongPHD - SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    4605              : 
    4606         1056 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    4607              : 
    4608              :     /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
    4609         1056 :     SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
    4610              :                     PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4611         1056 : }
    4612              : 
    4613              : /*
    4614              :  * Utility wrapper to update the control file.  Note that the control
    4615              :  * file gets flushed.
    4616              :  */
    4617              : static void
    4618         9612 : UpdateControlFile(void)
    4619              : {
    4620         9612 :     update_controlfile(DataDir, ControlFile, true);
    4621         9612 : }
    4622              : 
    4623              : /*
    4624              :  * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
    4625              :  */
    4626              : uint64
    4627         1468 : GetSystemIdentifier(void)
    4628              : {
    4629              :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4630         1468 :     return ControlFile->system_identifier;
    4631              : }
    4632              : 
    4633              : /*
    4634              :  * Returns the random nonce from control file.
    4635              :  */
    4636              : char *
    4637            2 : GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
    4638              : {
    4639              :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4640            2 :     return ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce;
    4641              : }
    4642              : 
    4643              : /*
    4644              :  * Are checksums enabled for data pages?
    4645              :  */
    4646              : bool
    4647     10547811 : DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
    4648              : {
    4649              :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4650     10547811 :     return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
    4651              : }
    4652              : 
    4653              : /*
    4654              :  * Return true if the cluster was initialized on a platform where the
    4655              :  * default signedness of char is "signed". This function exists for code
    4656              :  * that deals with pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char'
    4657              :  * type on disk (e.g., GIN and GiST indexes). See the comments in
    4658              :  * WriteControlFile() for details.
    4659              :  */
    4660              : bool
    4661            4 : GetDefaultCharSignedness(void)
    4662              : {
    4663            4 :     return ControlFile->default_char_signedness;
    4664              : }
    4665              : 
    4666              : /*
    4667              :  * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
    4668              :  *
    4669              :  * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
    4670              :  * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
    4671              :  * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
    4672              :  * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
    4673              :  * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
    4674              :  */
    4675              : XLogRecPtr
    4676           33 : GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
    4677              : {
    4678           33 :     return pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN, 1);
    4679              : }
    4680              : 
    4681              : /*
    4682              :  * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
    4683              :  *
    4684              :  * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
    4685              :  * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
    4686              :  * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
    4687              :  * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
    4688              :  * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
    4689              :  *
    4690              :  * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
    4691              :  */
    4692              : static int
    4693         1148 : XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
    4694              : {
    4695              :     int         xbuffers;
    4696              : 
    4697         1148 :     xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
    4698         1148 :     if (xbuffers > (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ))
    4699           24 :         xbuffers = (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    4700         1148 :     if (xbuffers < 8)
    4701          446 :         xbuffers = 8;
    4702         1148 :     return xbuffers;
    4703              : }
    4704              : 
    4705              : /*
    4706              :  * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
    4707              :  */
    4708              : bool
    4709         2336 : check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    4710              : {
    4711              :     /*
    4712              :      * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
    4713              :      */
    4714         2336 :     if (*newval == -1)
    4715              :     {
    4716              :         /*
    4717              :          * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
    4718              :          * be.  We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
    4719              :          */
    4720         1188 :         if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
    4721         1188 :             return true;
    4722              : 
    4723              :         /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
    4724            0 :         *newval = XLOGChooseNumBuffers();
    4725              :     }
    4726              : 
    4727              :     /*
    4728              :      * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks.  Prior to PostgreSQL
    4729              :      * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
    4730              :      * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
    4731              :      * minimum.  (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
    4732              :      * helpful.)
    4733              :      */
    4734         1148 :     if (*newval < 4)
    4735            0 :         *newval = 4;
    4736              : 
    4737         1148 :     return true;
    4738              : }
    4739              : 
    4740              : /*
    4741              :  * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
    4742              :  */
    4743              : bool
    4744         2166 : check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    4745              : {
    4746              :     char       *rawstring;
    4747              :     List       *elemlist;
    4748              :     ListCell   *l;
    4749              :     bool        newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
    4750              : 
    4751              :     /* Initialize the array */
    4752        71478 :     MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4753              : 
    4754              :     /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
    4755         2166 :     rawstring = pstrdup(*newval);
    4756              : 
    4757              :     /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
    4758         2166 :     if (!SplitIdentifierString(rawstring, ',', &elemlist))
    4759              :     {
    4760              :         /* syntax error in list */
    4761            0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
    4762            0 :         pfree(rawstring);
    4763            0 :         list_free(elemlist);
    4764            0 :         return false;
    4765              :     }
    4766              : 
    4767         2658 :     foreach(l, elemlist)
    4768              :     {
    4769          492 :         char       *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
    4770              :         int         rmid;
    4771              : 
    4772              :         /* Check for 'all'. */
    4773          492 :         if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
    4774              :         {
    4775       125930 :             for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
    4776       125440 :                 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
    4777         4900 :                     newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
    4778              :         }
    4779              :         else
    4780              :         {
    4781              :             /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
    4782            2 :             bool        found = false;
    4783              : 
    4784           36 :             for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
    4785              :             {
    4786           54 :                 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
    4787           18 :                     pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
    4788              :                 {
    4789            2 :                     newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
    4790            2 :                     found = true;
    4791            2 :                     break;
    4792              :                 }
    4793              :             }
    4794            2 :             if (!found)
    4795              :             {
    4796              :                 /*
    4797              :                  * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
    4798              :                  * resource manager.  Defer checking until
    4799              :                  * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
    4800              :                  */
    4801            0 :                 if (!process_shared_preload_libraries_done)
    4802              :                 {
    4803            0 :                     check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = true;
    4804              :                 }
    4805              :                 else
    4806              :                 {
    4807            0 :                     GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
    4808            0 :                     pfree(rawstring);
    4809            0 :                     list_free(elemlist);
    4810            0 :                     return false;
    4811              :                 }
    4812              :             }
    4813              :         }
    4814              :     }
    4815              : 
    4816         2166 :     pfree(rawstring);
    4817         2166 :     list_free(elemlist);
    4818              : 
    4819              :     /* assign new value */
    4820         2166 :     *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4821         2166 :     if (!*extra)
    4822            0 :         return false;
    4823         2166 :     memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4824         2166 :     return true;
    4825              : }
    4826              : 
    4827              : /*
    4828              :  * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
    4829              :  */
    4830              : void
    4831         2165 : assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
    4832              : {
    4833              :     /*
    4834              :      * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
    4835              :      * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
    4836              :      * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
    4837              :      * assignment.
    4838              :      *
    4839              :      * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
    4840              :      * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
    4841              :      * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
    4842              :      * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
    4843              :      * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
    4844              :      * module is loaded anyway.
    4845              :      */
    4846         2165 :     wal_consistency_checking = extra;
    4847         2165 : }
    4848              : 
    4849              : /*
    4850              :  * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
    4851              :  *
    4852              :  * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
    4853              :  * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred.  Now that
    4854              :  * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
    4855              :  * again.
    4856              :  */
    4857              : void
    4858          995 : InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
    4859              : {
    4860              :     Assert(process_shared_preload_libraries_done);
    4861              : 
    4862          995 :     if (check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred)
    4863              :     {
    4864              :         struct config_generic *guc;
    4865              : 
    4866            0 :         guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
    4867              : 
    4868            0 :         check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false;
    4869              : 
    4870            0 :         set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
    4871              :                               wal_consistency_checking_string,
    4872              :                               guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
    4873              :                               GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
    4874              : 
    4875              :         /* checking should not be deferred again */
    4876              :         Assert(!check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred);
    4877              :     }
    4878          995 : }
    4879              : 
    4880              : /*
    4881              :  * GUC show_hook for archive_command
    4882              :  */
    4883              : const char *
    4884         1793 : show_archive_command(void)
    4885              : {
    4886         1793 :     if (XLogArchivingActive())
    4887            2 :         return XLogArchiveCommand;
    4888              :     else
    4889         1791 :         return "(disabled)";
    4890              : }
    4891              : 
    4892              : /*
    4893              :  * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
    4894              :  */
    4895              : const char *
    4896        16120 : show_in_hot_standby(void)
    4897              : {
    4898              :     /*
    4899              :      * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
    4900              :      * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query.  The underlying
    4901              :      * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
    4902              :      * to the client.
    4903              :      */
    4904        16120 :     return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
    4905              : }
    4906              : 
    4907              : /*
    4908              :  * GUC show_hook for effective_wal_level
    4909              :  */
    4910              : const char *
    4911         1822 : show_effective_wal_level(void)
    4912              : {
    4913         1822 :     if (wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL)
    4914          257 :         return "minimal";
    4915              : 
    4916              :     /*
    4917              :      * During recovery, effective_wal_level reflects the primary's
    4918              :      * configuration rather than the local wal_level value.
    4919              :      */
    4920         1565 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    4921           22 :         return IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled() ? "logical" : "replica";
    4922              : 
    4923         1543 :     return XLogLogicalInfoActive() ? "logical" : "replica";
    4924              : }
    4925              : 
    4926              : /*
    4927              :  * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
    4928              :  *
    4929              :  * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
    4930              :  * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists.  As there's no
    4931              :  * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
    4932              :  * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
    4933              :  * will then copy it to shared memory later.
    4934              :  *
    4935              :  * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
    4936              :  * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
    4937              :  */
    4938              : void
    4939         1005 : LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
    4940              : {
    4941              :     Assert(reset || ControlFile == NULL);
    4942         1005 :     ControlFile = palloc_object(ControlFileData);
    4943         1005 :     ReadControlFile();
    4944         1005 : }
    4945              : 
    4946              : /*
    4947              :  * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
    4948              :  * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
    4949              :  * was originally configured on standby.
    4950              :  */
    4951              : WalLevel
    4952            0 : GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
    4953              : {
    4954            0 :     return ControlFile->wal_level;
    4955              : }
    4956              : 
    4957              : /*
    4958              :  * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
    4959              :  */
    4960              : Size
    4961         3297 : XLOGShmemSize(void)
    4962              : {
    4963              :     Size        size;
    4964              : 
    4965              :     /*
    4966              :      * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
    4967              :      * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
    4968              :      * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
    4969              :      * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
    4970              :      *
    4971              :      * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
    4972              :      * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
    4973              :      * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
    4974              :      * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
    4975              :      */
    4976         3297 :     if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
    4977              :     {
    4978              :         char        buf[32];
    4979              : 
    4980         1148 :         snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
    4981         1148 :         SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
    4982              :                         PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4983         1148 :         if (XLOGbuffers == -1)  /* failed to apply it? */
    4984            0 :             SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
    4985              :                             PGC_S_OVERRIDE);
    4986              :     }
    4987              :     Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
    4988              : 
    4989              :     /* XLogCtl */
    4990         3297 :     size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
    4991              : 
    4992              :     /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
    4993         3297 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
    4994              :     /* xlblocks array */
    4995         3297 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
    4996              :     /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
    4997         3297 :     size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
    4998              :     /* and the buffers themselves */
    4999         3297 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
    5000              : 
    5001              :     /*
    5002              :      * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
    5003              :      * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores.  This lets us use this
    5004              :      * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
    5005              :      */
    5006              : 
    5007         3297 :     return size;
    5008              : }
    5009              : 
    5010              : void
    5011         1150 : XLOGShmemInit(void)
    5012              : {
    5013              :     bool        foundCFile,
    5014              :                 foundXLog;
    5015              :     char       *allocptr;
    5016              :     int         i;
    5017              :     ControlFileData *localControlFile;
    5018              : 
    5019              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    5020              : 
    5021              :     /*
    5022              :      * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
    5023              :      * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
    5024              :      * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
    5025              :      */
    5026              :     if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
    5027              :     {
    5028              :         walDebugCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(TopMemoryContext,
    5029              :                                             "WAL Debug",
    5030              :                                             ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    5031              :         MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(walDebugCxt, true);
    5032              :     }
    5033              : #endif
    5034              : 
    5035              : 
    5036         1150 :     XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
    5037         1150 :         ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
    5038              : 
    5039         1150 :     localControlFile = ControlFile;
    5040         1150 :     ControlFile = (ControlFileData *)
    5041         1150 :         ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
    5042              : 
    5043         1150 :     if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
    5044              :     {
    5045              :         /* both should be present or neither */
    5046              :         Assert(foundCFile && foundXLog);
    5047              : 
    5048              :         /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
    5049            0 :         WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks;
    5050              : 
    5051            0 :         if (localControlFile)
    5052            0 :             pfree(localControlFile);
    5053            0 :         return;
    5054              :     }
    5055         1150 :     memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
    5056              : 
    5057              :     /*
    5058              :      * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
    5059              :      * contents into shared memory.
    5060              :      */
    5061         1150 :     if (localControlFile)
    5062              :     {
    5063          997 :         memcpy(ControlFile, localControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    5064          997 :         pfree(localControlFile);
    5065              :     }
    5066              : 
    5067              :     /*
    5068              :      * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
    5069              :      * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
    5070              :      * needed here.
    5071              :      */
    5072         1150 :     allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
    5073         1150 :     XLogCtl->xlblocks = (pg_atomic_uint64 *) allocptr;
    5074         1150 :     allocptr += sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64) * XLOGbuffers;
    5075              : 
    5076       329907 :     for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
    5077              :     {
    5078       328757 :         pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[i], InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5079              :     }
    5080              : 
    5081              :     /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
    5082         1150 :     allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
    5083         1150 :         ((uintptr_t) allocptr) % sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded);
    5084         1150 :     WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks =
    5085              :         (WALInsertLockPadded *) allocptr;
    5086         1150 :     allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) * NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    5087              : 
    5088        10350 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    5089              :     {
    5090         9200 :         LWLockInitialize(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LWTRANCHE_WAL_INSERT);
    5091         9200 :         pg_atomic_init_u64(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5092         9200 :         WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5093              :     }
    5094              : 
    5095              :     /*
    5096              :      * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
    5097              :      * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
    5098              :      * required for O_DIRECT.
    5099              :      */
    5100         1150 :     allocptr = (char *) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, allocptr);
    5101         1150 :     XLogCtl->pages = allocptr;
    5102         1150 :     memset(XLogCtl->pages, 0, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ * XLOGbuffers);
    5103              : 
    5104              :     /*
    5105              :      * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
    5106              :      * in additional info.)
    5107              :      */
    5108         1150 :     XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck = XLOGbuffers - 1;
    5109         1150 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
    5110         1150 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = false;
    5111         1150 :     XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
    5112              : 
    5113         1150 :     SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->Insert.insertpos_lck);
    5114         1150 :     SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5115         1150 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5116         1150 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5117         1150 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5118         1150 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5119              : }
    5120              : 
    5121              : /*
    5122              :  * This func must be called ONCE on system install.  It creates pg_control
    5123              :  * and the initial XLOG segment.
    5124              :  */
    5125              : void
    5126           51 : BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
    5127              : {
    5128              :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    5129              :     PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
    5130              :     XLogPageHeader page;
    5131              :     XLogLongPageHeader longpage;
    5132              :     XLogRecord *record;
    5133              :     char       *recptr;
    5134              :     uint64      sysidentifier;
    5135              :     struct timeval tv;
    5136              :     pg_crc32c   crc;
    5137              : 
    5138              :     /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
    5139           51 :     SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    5140              : 
    5141              :     /*
    5142              :      * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
    5143              :      * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
    5144              :      * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get.  (Think not to
    5145              :      * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
    5146              :      * to seed it other than the system clock value...)  The upper half of the
    5147              :      * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
    5148              :      * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
    5149              :      * PID for a little extra uniqueness.  A person knowing this encoding can
    5150              :      * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
    5151              :      * perhaps be useful sometimes.
    5152              :      */
    5153           51 :     gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
    5154           51 :     sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
    5155           51 :     sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
    5156           51 :     sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
    5157              : 
    5158           51 :     memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
    5159           51 :     page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
    5160              : 
    5161              :     /*
    5162              :      * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
    5163              :      *
    5164              :      * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
    5165              :      * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
    5166              :      * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
    5167              :      */
    5168           51 :     checkPoint.redo = wal_segment_size + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    5169           51 :     checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5170           51 :     checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5171           51 :     checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
    5172           51 :     checkPoint.logicalDecodingEnabled = (wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL);
    5173           51 :     checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
    5174              :     checkPoint.nextXid =
    5175           51 :         FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(0, FirstNormalTransactionId);
    5176           51 :     checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
    5177           51 :     checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
    5178           51 :     checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
    5179           51 :     checkPoint.oldestXid = FirstNormalTransactionId;
    5180           51 :     checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
    5181           51 :     checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
    5182           51 :     checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
    5183           51 :     checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5184           51 :     checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5185           51 :     checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    5186           51 :     checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5187              : 
    5188           51 :     TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5189           51 :     TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    5190           51 :     TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    5191           51 :     MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    5192           51 :     AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
    5193           51 :     SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    5194           51 :     SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    5195           51 :     SetCommitTsLimit(InvalidTransactionId, InvalidTransactionId);
    5196              : 
    5197              :     /* Set up the XLOG page header */
    5198           51 :     page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
    5199           51 :     page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
    5200           51 :     page->xlp_tli = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5201           51 :     page->xlp_pageaddr = wal_segment_size;
    5202           51 :     longpage = (XLogLongPageHeader) page;
    5203           51 :     longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
    5204           51 :     longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    5205           51 :     longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    5206              : 
    5207              :     /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
    5208           51 :     recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
    5209           51 :     record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
    5210           51 :     record->xl_prev = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5211           51 :     record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5212           51 :     record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
    5213           51 :     record->xl_info = XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN;
    5214           51 :     record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
    5215           51 :     recptr += SizeOfXLogRecord;
    5216              :     /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
    5217           51 :     *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
    5218           51 :     *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
    5219           51 :     memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
    5220           51 :     recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
    5221              :     Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
    5222              : 
    5223           51 :     INIT_CRC32C(crc);
    5224           51 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
    5225           51 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
    5226           51 :     FIN_CRC32C(crc);
    5227           51 :     record->xl_crc = crc;
    5228              : 
    5229              :     /* Create first XLOG segment file */
    5230           51 :     openLogTLI = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5231           51 :     openLogFile = XLogFileInit(1, BootstrapTimeLineID);
    5232              : 
    5233              :     /*
    5234              :      * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
    5235              :      * close the file again in a moment.
    5236              :      */
    5237              : 
    5238              :     /* Write the first page with the initial record */
    5239           51 :     errno = 0;
    5240           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_WRITE);
    5241           51 :     if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    5242              :     {
    5243              :         /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    5244            0 :         if (errno == 0)
    5245            0 :             errno = ENOSPC;
    5246            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5247              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5248              :                  errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5249              :     }
    5250           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    5251              : 
    5252           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_SYNC);
    5253           51 :     if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
    5254            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5255              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5256              :                  errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5257           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    5258              : 
    5259           51 :     if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
    5260            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5261              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5262              :                  errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5263              : 
    5264           51 :     openLogFile = -1;
    5265              : 
    5266              :     /* Now create pg_control */
    5267           51 :     InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
    5268           51 :     ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
    5269           51 :     ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
    5270           51 :     ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
    5271              : 
    5272              :     /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
    5273           51 :     WriteControlFile();
    5274              : 
    5275              :     /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
    5276           51 :     BootStrapCLOG();
    5277           51 :     BootStrapCommitTs();
    5278           51 :     BootStrapSUBTRANS();
    5279           51 :     BootStrapMultiXact();
    5280              : 
    5281              :     /*
    5282              :      * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
    5283              :      * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
    5284              :      */
    5285           51 :     ReadControlFile();
    5286           51 : }
    5287              : 
    5288              : static char *
    5289          892 : str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
    5290              : {
    5291          892 :     pg_strftime(buf, bufsize,
    5292              :                 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
    5293          892 :                 pg_localtime(&tnow, log_timezone));
    5294              : 
    5295          892 :     return buf;
    5296              : }
    5297              : 
    5298              : /*
    5299              :  * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
    5300              :  */
    5301              : static void
    5302           54 : XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
    5303              : {
    5304              :     char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5305              :     XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    5306              :     XLogSegNo   startLogSegNo;
    5307              : 
    5308              :     /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
    5309              :     Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
    5310              : 
    5311              :     /*
    5312              :      * Update min recovery point one last time.
    5313              :      */
    5314           54 :     UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
    5315              : 
    5316              :     /*
    5317              :      * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
    5318              :      * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
    5319              :      * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
    5320              :      * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
    5321              :      */
    5322           54 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(endOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5323           54 :     XLByteToSeg(endOfLog, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5324              : 
    5325              :     /*
    5326              :      * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
    5327              :      * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
    5328              :      * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
    5329              :      * on the new timeline.
    5330              :      */
    5331           54 :     if (endLogSegNo == startLogSegNo)
    5332              :     {
    5333              :         /*
    5334              :          * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
    5335              :          *
    5336              :          * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
    5337              :          * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
    5338              :          * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
    5339              :          */
    5340           44 :         XLogFileCopy(newTLI, endLogSegNo, endTLI, endLogSegNo,
    5341           44 :                      XLogSegmentOffset(endOfLog, wal_segment_size));
    5342              :     }
    5343              :     else
    5344              :     {
    5345              :         /*
    5346              :          * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
    5347              :          * segment on the new timeline.
    5348              :          */
    5349              :         int         fd;
    5350              : 
    5351           10 :         fd = XLogFileInit(startLogSegNo, newTLI);
    5352              : 
    5353           10 :         if (close(fd) != 0)
    5354              :         {
    5355            0 :             int         save_errno = errno;
    5356              : 
    5357            0 :             XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5358            0 :             errno = save_errno;
    5359            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    5360              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5361              :                      errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    5362              :         }
    5363              :     }
    5364              : 
    5365              :     /*
    5366              :      * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
    5367              :      * for the new segment.
    5368              :      */
    5369           54 :     XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5370           54 :     XLogArchiveCleanup(xlogfname);
    5371           54 : }
    5372              : 
    5373              : /*
    5374              :  * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
    5375              :  */
    5376              : static void
    5377           54 : CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog,
    5378              :                             TimeLineID newTLI)
    5379              : {
    5380              :     /*
    5381              :      * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
    5382              :      */
    5383           54 :     if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0)
    5384            2 :         ExecuteRecoveryCommand(recoveryEndCommand,
    5385              :                                "recovery_end_command",
    5386              :                                true,
    5387              :                                WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_END_COMMAND);
    5388              : 
    5389              :     /*
    5390              :      * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
    5391              :      *
    5392              :      * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
    5393              :      * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
    5394              :      * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
    5395              :      * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
    5396              :      */
    5397           54 :     RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
    5398              : 
    5399              :     /*
    5400              :      * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
    5401              :      * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
    5402              :      * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
    5403              :      * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
    5404              :      * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
    5405              :      * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
    5406              :      * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
    5407              :      * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
    5408              :      * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
    5409              :      * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
    5410              :      * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
    5411              :      * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
    5412              :      * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
    5413              :      * caused such problems).
    5414              :      *
    5415              :      * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
    5416              :      * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
    5417              :      * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
    5418              :      * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
    5419              :      * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
    5420              :      *
    5421              :      * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
    5422              :      * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
    5423              :      * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
    5424              :      * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
    5425              :      */
    5426           54 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(EndOfLog, wal_segment_size) != 0 &&
    5427              :         XLogArchivingActive())
    5428              :     {
    5429              :         char        origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5430              :         XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    5431              : 
    5432            9 :         XLByteToPrevSeg(EndOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5433            9 :         XLogFileName(origfname, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5434              : 
    5435            9 :         if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(origfname))
    5436              :         {
    5437              :             char        origpath[MAXPGPATH];
    5438              :             char        partialfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5439              :             char        partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
    5440              : 
    5441              :             /*
    5442              :              * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
    5443              :              * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
    5444              :              */
    5445            5 :             if (summarize_wal)
    5446            1 :                 WaitForWalSummarization(EndOfLog);
    5447              : 
    5448            5 :             XLogFilePath(origpath, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5449            5 :             snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
    5450            5 :             snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
    5451              : 
    5452              :             /*
    5453              :              * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
    5454              :              * file.
    5455              :              */
    5456            5 :             XLogArchiveCleanup(partialfname);
    5457              : 
    5458            5 :             durable_rename(origpath, partialpath, ERROR);
    5459            5 :             XLogArchiveNotify(partialfname);
    5460              :         }
    5461              :     }
    5462           54 : }
    5463              : 
    5464              : /*
    5465              :  * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
    5466              :  * for various aspects of recovery operation.
    5467              :  *
    5468              :  * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
    5469              :  * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
    5470              :  * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
    5471              :  */
    5472              : static void
    5473          261 : CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
    5474              : {
    5475              :     /*
    5476              :      * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
    5477              :      * wal_level.
    5478              :      */
    5479          261 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && ControlFile->wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL)
    5480              :     {
    5481            2 :         ereport(FATAL,
    5482              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5483              :                  errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
    5484              :                  errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
    5485              :                  errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
    5486              :     }
    5487              : 
    5488              :     /*
    5489              :      * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
    5490              :      * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
    5491              :      */
    5492          259 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
    5493              :     {
    5494              :         /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
    5495          135 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
    5496              :                                      MaxConnections,
    5497          135 :                                      ControlFile->MaxConnections);
    5498          135 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
    5499              :                                      max_worker_processes,
    5500          135 :                                      ControlFile->max_worker_processes);
    5501          135 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
    5502              :                                      max_wal_senders,
    5503          135 :                                      ControlFile->max_wal_senders);
    5504          135 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
    5505              :                                      max_prepared_xacts,
    5506          135 :                                      ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts);
    5507          135 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
    5508              :                                      max_locks_per_xact,
    5509          135 :                                      ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact);
    5510              :     }
    5511          259 : }
    5512              : 
    5513              : /*
    5514              :  * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
    5515              :  */
    5516              : void
    5517         1004 : StartupXLOG(void)
    5518              : {
    5519              :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert;
    5520              :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    5521              :     bool        wasShutdown;
    5522              :     bool        didCrash;
    5523              :     bool        haveTblspcMap;
    5524              :     bool        haveBackupLabel;
    5525              :     XLogRecPtr  EndOfLog;
    5526              :     TimeLineID  EndOfLogTLI;
    5527              :     TimeLineID  newTLI;
    5528              :     bool        performedWalRecovery;
    5529              :     EndOfWalRecoveryInfo *endOfRecoveryInfo;
    5530              :     XLogRecPtr  abortedRecPtr;
    5531              :     XLogRecPtr  missingContrecPtr;
    5532              :     TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
    5533         1004 :     bool        promoted = false;
    5534              :     char        timebuf[128];
    5535              : 
    5536              :     /*
    5537              :      * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
    5538              :      * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
    5539              :      */
    5540              :     Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
    5541              :     Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
    5542              :            CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
    5543         1004 :     CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
    5544              : 
    5545              :     /*
    5546              :      * Check that contents look valid.
    5547              :      */
    5548         1004 :     if (!XRecOffIsValid(ControlFile->checkPoint))
    5549            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    5550              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    5551              :                  errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
    5552              : 
    5553         1004 :     switch (ControlFile->state)
    5554              :     {
    5555          786 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
    5556              : 
    5557              :             /*
    5558              :              * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
    5559              :              * mode
    5560              :              */
    5561          786 :             ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
    5562              :                     (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
    5563              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5564              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5565          786 :             break;
    5566              : 
    5567           33 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY:
    5568           33 :             ereport(LOG,
    5569              :                     (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
    5570              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5571              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5572           33 :             break;
    5573              : 
    5574            0 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
    5575            0 :             ereport(LOG,
    5576              :                     (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
    5577              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5578              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5579            0 :             break;
    5580              : 
    5581            0 :         case DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY:
    5582            0 :             ereport(LOG,
    5583              :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
    5584              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5585              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
    5586              :                      errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
    5587              :                              " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
    5588            0 :             break;
    5589              : 
    5590            7 :         case DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY:
    5591            7 :             ereport(LOG,
    5592              :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
    5593              :                             str_time(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.time,
    5594              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
    5595              :                      errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
    5596              :                              " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
    5597            7 :             break;
    5598              : 
    5599          178 :         case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
    5600          178 :             ereport(LOG,
    5601              :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
    5602              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5603              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5604          178 :             break;
    5605              : 
    5606            0 :         default:
    5607            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    5608              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    5609              :                      errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
    5610              :     }
    5611              : 
    5612              :     /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
    5613              : #ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
    5614              :     if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED)
    5615              :         pg_usleep(60000000L);
    5616              : #endif
    5617              : 
    5618              :     /*
    5619              :      * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
    5620              :      * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
    5621              :      * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
    5622              :      */
    5623         1004 :     ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure();
    5624              : 
    5625              :     /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
    5626         1004 :     if (!IsBootstrapProcessingMode())
    5627          953 :         RegisterTimeout(STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT,
    5628              :                         startup_progress_timeout_handler);
    5629              : 
    5630              :     /*----------
    5631              :      * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
    5632              :      *
    5633              :      * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
    5634              :      *   used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
    5635              :      *   bloat this path.  This is done first as there is no point to sync
    5636              :      *   this temporary data.
    5637              :      *
    5638              :      * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
    5639              :      *   which we had not actually fsync'd yet.  Therefore, a power failure in
    5640              :      *   the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
    5641              :      *   though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
    5642              :      *   persisted.  To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
    5643              :      */
    5644         1004 :     if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED &&
    5645          218 :         ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY)
    5646              :     {
    5647          185 :         RemoveTempXlogFiles();
    5648          185 :         SyncDataDirectory();
    5649          185 :         didCrash = true;
    5650              :     }
    5651              :     else
    5652          819 :         didCrash = false;
    5653              : 
    5654              :     /*
    5655              :      * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
    5656              :      *
    5657              :      * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
    5658              :      * any.  It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
    5659              :      * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
    5660              :      * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
    5661              :      */
    5662         1004 :     InitWalRecovery(ControlFile, &wasShutdown,
    5663              :                     &haveBackupLabel, &haveTblspcMap);
    5664         1003 :     checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
    5665              : 
    5666              :     /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
    5667         1003 :     TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5668         1003 :     TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    5669         1003 :     TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    5670         1003 :     MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    5671         1003 :     AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
    5672         1003 :     SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    5673         1003 :     SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    5674         1003 :     SetCommitTsLimit(checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid,
    5675              :                      checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
    5676              : 
    5677              :     /*
    5678              :      * Clear out any old relcache cache files.  This is *necessary* if we do
    5679              :      * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
    5680              :      * being out of sync with database reality.  In theory we could leave them
    5681              :      * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
    5682              :      * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
    5683              :      * first backend startup.  These files needs to be removed from all
    5684              :      * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
    5685              :      * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
    5686              :      * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
    5687              :      * symlinks.
    5688              :      */
    5689         1003 :     RelationCacheInitFileRemove();
    5690              : 
    5691              :     /*
    5692              :      * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
    5693              :      * required resources.
    5694              :      */
    5695         1003 :     StartupReplicationSlots();
    5696              : 
    5697              :     /*
    5698              :      * Startup the logical decoding status with the last status stored in the
    5699              :      * checkpoint record.
    5700              :      */
    5701         1001 :     StartupLogicalDecodingStatus(checkPoint.logicalDecodingEnabled);
    5702              : 
    5703              :     /*
    5704              :      * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
    5705              :      * during crash recovery.
    5706              :      */
    5707         1001 :     StartupReorderBuffer();
    5708              : 
    5709              :     /*
    5710              :      * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
    5711              :      * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
    5712              :      */
    5713         1001 :     StartupCLOG();
    5714              : 
    5715              :     /*
    5716              :      * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
    5717              :      * truncations.
    5718              :      */
    5719         1001 :     StartupMultiXact();
    5720              : 
    5721              :     /*
    5722              :      * Ditto for commit timestamps.  Activate the facility if the setting is
    5723              :      * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
    5724              :      * timestamps done when the setting was disabled.  This facility can be
    5725              :      * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
    5726              :      */
    5727         1001 :     if (ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
    5728           14 :         StartupCommitTs();
    5729              : 
    5730              :     /*
    5731              :      * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
    5732              :      */
    5733         1001 :     StartupReplicationOrigin();
    5734              : 
    5735              :     /*
    5736              :      * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
    5737              :      * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
    5738              :      * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
    5739              :      */
    5740         1001 :     if (ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED)
    5741          778 :         pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN,
    5742          778 :                                        ControlFile->unloggedLSN);
    5743              :     else
    5744          223 :         pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN,
    5745              :                                        FirstNormalUnloggedLSN);
    5746              : 
    5747              :     /*
    5748              :      * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
    5749              :      * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
    5750              :      * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
    5751              :      * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
    5752              :      * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
    5753              :      * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
    5754              :      * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
    5755              :      * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
    5756              :      * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
    5757              :      * and regret later.
    5758              :      */
    5759         1001 :     restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI);
    5760              : 
    5761              :     /*
    5762              :      * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
    5763              :      * be able to work on entries generated by redo.  Doing a scan before
    5764              :      * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
    5765              :      * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
    5766              :      * replay.  This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
    5767              :      * of the on-disk two-phase data.
    5768              :      */
    5769         1001 :     restoreTwoPhaseData();
    5770              : 
    5771              :     /*
    5772              :      * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
    5773              :      * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
    5774              :      * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
    5775              :      *
    5776              :      * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
    5777              :      * already been restored from disk.
    5778              :      *
    5779              :      * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
    5780              :      * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
    5781              :      */
    5782         1001 :     if (didCrash)
    5783          184 :         pgstat_discard_stats();
    5784              :     else
    5785          817 :         pgstat_restore_stats();
    5786              : 
    5787         1001 :     lastFullPageWrites = checkPoint.fullPageWrites;
    5788              : 
    5789         1001 :     RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    5790         1001 :     doPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
    5791              : 
    5792              :     /* REDO */
    5793         1001 :     if (InRecovery)
    5794              :     {
    5795              :         /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
    5796          223 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5797          223 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    5798          120 :             XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
    5799              :         else
    5800          103 :             XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
    5801          223 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5802              : 
    5803              :         /*
    5804              :          * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
    5805              :          * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
    5806              :          * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
    5807              :          * backup history file.
    5808              :          *
    5809              :          * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
    5810              :          */
    5811          223 :         UpdateControlFile();
    5812              : 
    5813              :         /*
    5814              :          * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
    5815              :          * has now been propagated into pg_control.  We must get rid of the
    5816              :          * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
    5817              :          * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
    5818              :          * to the backup start point.  It seems prudent though to just rename
    5819              :          * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
    5820              :          */
    5821          223 :         if (haveBackupLabel)
    5822              :         {
    5823           79 :             unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD);
    5824           79 :             durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, FATAL);
    5825              :         }
    5826              : 
    5827              :         /*
    5828              :          * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
    5829              :          * symlinks have been created.  We must get rid of the map file so
    5830              :          * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
    5831              :          * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
    5832              :          * rather than delete it completely.
    5833              :          */
    5834          223 :         if (haveTblspcMap)
    5835              :         {
    5836            2 :             unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
    5837            2 :             durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, FATAL);
    5838              :         }
    5839              : 
    5840              :         /*
    5841              :          * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint.  When doing crash
    5842              :          * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL.  Particularly, in
    5843              :          * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
    5844              :          * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint.  However,
    5845              :          * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
    5846              :          * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
    5847              :          * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
    5848              :          * references when checking for data consistency.
    5849              :          */
    5850          223 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    5851              :         {
    5852          120 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    5853          120 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    5854              :         }
    5855              :         else
    5856              :         {
    5857          103 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5858          103 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
    5859              :         }
    5860              : 
    5861              :         /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
    5862          223 :         CheckRequiredParameterValues();
    5863              : 
    5864              :         /*
    5865              :          * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
    5866              :          * reset.  This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
    5867              :          * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
    5868              :          * garbage is left over from before.
    5869              :          */
    5870          223 :         ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP);
    5871              : 
    5872              :         /*
    5873              :          * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
    5874              :          * behind by crashed backends.
    5875              :          */
    5876          223 :         DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles();
    5877              : 
    5878              :         /*
    5879              :          * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
    5880              :          * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
    5881              :          * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
    5882              :          * running-xacts WAL record.
    5883              :          */
    5884          223 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
    5885              :         {
    5886              :             TransactionId *xids;
    5887              :             int         nxids;
    5888              : 
    5889          113 :             ereport(DEBUG1,
    5890              :                     (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
    5891              : 
    5892          113 :             InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
    5893              : 
    5894          113 :             if (wasShutdown)
    5895           26 :                 oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
    5896              :             else
    5897           87 :                 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
    5898              :             Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(oldestActiveXID));
    5899              : 
    5900              :             /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
    5901          113 :             ProcArrayInitRecovery(XidFromFullTransactionId(TransamVariables->nextXid));
    5902              : 
    5903              :             /*
    5904              :              * Startup subtrans only.  CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
    5905              :              * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
    5906              :              * during recovery and need not be started yet.
    5907              :              */
    5908          113 :             StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
    5909              : 
    5910              :             /*
    5911              :              * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
    5912              :              * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
    5913              :              * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
    5914              :              * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
    5915              :              */
    5916          113 :             if (wasShutdown)
    5917              :             {
    5918              :                 RunningTransactionsData running;
    5919              :                 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
    5920              : 
    5921              :                 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
    5922           26 :                 StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
    5923              : 
    5924              :                 /*
    5925              :                  * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
    5926              :                  * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
    5927              :                  * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
    5928              :                  * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
    5929              :                  */
    5930           26 :                 running.xcnt = nxids;
    5931           26 :                 running.subxcnt = 0;
    5932           26 :                 running.subxid_status = SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS;
    5933           26 :                 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    5934           26 :                 running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
    5935           26 :                 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    5936           26 :                 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
    5937              :                 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
    5938           26 :                 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
    5939           26 :                 running.xids = xids;
    5940              : 
    5941           26 :                 ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
    5942              :             }
    5943              :         }
    5944              : 
    5945              :         /*
    5946              :          * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
    5947              :          */
    5948          223 :         PerformWalRecovery();
    5949          162 :         performedWalRecovery = true;
    5950              :     }
    5951              :     else
    5952          778 :         performedWalRecovery = false;
    5953              : 
    5954              :     /*
    5955              :      * Finish WAL recovery.
    5956              :      */
    5957          940 :     endOfRecoveryInfo = FinishWalRecovery();
    5958          940 :     EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
    5959          940 :     EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
    5960          940 :     abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
    5961          940 :     missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
    5962              : 
    5963              :     /*
    5964              :      * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
    5965              :      * up.
    5966              :      */
    5967          940 :     set_ps_display("");
    5968              : 
    5969              :     /*
    5970              :      * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
    5971              :      * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
    5972              :      * the point where the database is consistent.  For regular online
    5973              :      * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
    5974              :      * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
    5975              :      * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
    5976              :      * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
    5977              :      * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica).  For
    5978              :      * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
    5979              :      * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
    5980              :      * to false.
    5981              :      *
    5982              :      * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
    5983              :      * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
    5984              :      * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
    5985              :      * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
    5986              :      */
    5987          940 :     if (InRecovery &&
    5988          162 :         (EndOfLog < LocalMinRecoveryPoint ||
    5989          162 :          XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint)))
    5990              :     {
    5991              :         /*
    5992              :          * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
    5993              :          * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
    5994              :          * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
    5995              :          * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
    5996              :          */
    5997            0 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
    5998              :         {
    5999            0 :             if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
    6000            0 :                 ereport(FATAL,
    6001              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    6002              :                          errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
    6003              :                          errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
    6004              :             else
    6005            0 :                 ereport(FATAL,
    6006              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    6007              :                          errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
    6008              :         }
    6009              :     }
    6010              : 
    6011              :     /*
    6012              :      * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
    6013              :      * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
    6014              :      * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
    6015              :      * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
    6016              :      * end-of-recovery steps fail.
    6017              :      */
    6018          940 :     if (InRecovery)
    6019          162 :         ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT);
    6020              : 
    6021              :     /*
    6022              :      * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
    6023              :      * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
    6024              :      * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
    6025              :      */
    6026          940 :     oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(NULL, NULL);
    6027              : 
    6028              :     /*
    6029              :      * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
    6030              :      * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
    6031              :      */
    6032          940 :     SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    6033              : 
    6034              :     /*
    6035              :      * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
    6036              :      *
    6037              :      * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID.  This handles a
    6038              :      * couple of issues.  If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
    6039              :      * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
    6040              :      * it a unique new ID.  Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
    6041              :      * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
    6042              :      * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
    6043              :      * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that.  We can dodge the
    6044              :      * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
    6045              :      *
    6046              :      * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
    6047              :      */
    6048          940 :     newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
    6049          940 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
    6050              :     {
    6051           54 :         newTLI = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI) + 1;
    6052           54 :         ereport(LOG,
    6053              :                 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
    6054              : 
    6055              :         /*
    6056              :          * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment.  (Note that we also
    6057              :          * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
    6058              :          * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
    6059              :          */
    6060           54 :         XLogInitNewTimeline(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6061              : 
    6062              :         /*
    6063              :          * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
    6064              :          * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
    6065              :          */
    6066           54 :         if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
    6067           51 :             durable_unlink(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
    6068              : 
    6069           54 :         if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
    6070            4 :             durable_unlink(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
    6071              : 
    6072              :         /*
    6073              :          * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
    6074              :          * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
    6075              :          * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
    6076              :          * servers.  If we crash before actually switching to the new
    6077              :          * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
    6078              :          * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
    6079              :          * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
    6080              :          * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
    6081              :          */
    6082           54 :         writeTimeLineHistory(newTLI, recoveryTargetTLI,
    6083              :                              EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
    6084              : 
    6085           54 :         ereport(LOG,
    6086              :                 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
    6087              :     }
    6088              : 
    6089              :     /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
    6090          940 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6091          940 :     XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID = newTLI;
    6092          940 :     XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
    6093          940 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6094              : 
    6095              :     /*
    6096              :      * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
    6097              :      * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
    6098              :      * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
    6099              :      * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
    6100              :      */
    6101          940 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(missingContrecPtr))
    6102              :     {
    6103              :         /*
    6104              :          * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
    6105              :          * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
    6106              :          * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
    6107              :          * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
    6108              :          * disregard.
    6109              :          */
    6110              :         Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
    6111              :         Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(abortedRecPtr));
    6112           11 :         EndOfLog = missingContrecPtr;
    6113              :     }
    6114              : 
    6115              :     /*
    6116              :      * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
    6117              :      * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
    6118              :      * previous incarnation.
    6119              :      */
    6120          940 :     Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    6121          940 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRec);
    6122          940 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
    6123              : 
    6124              :     /*
    6125              :      * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
    6126              :      * record spans, not the one it starts in.  The last block is indeed the
    6127              :      * one we want to use.
    6128              :      */
    6129          940 :     if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
    6130              :     {
    6131              :         char       *page;
    6132              :         int         len;
    6133              :         int         firstIdx;
    6134              : 
    6135          911 :         firstIdx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(EndOfLog);
    6136          911 :         len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
    6137              :         Assert(len < XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    6138              : 
    6139              :         /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
    6140          911 :         page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
    6141          911 :         memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
    6142          911 :         memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
    6143              : 
    6144          911 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[firstIdx], endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    6145          911 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    6146              :     }
    6147              :     else
    6148              :     {
    6149              :         /*
    6150              :          * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
    6151              :          * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
    6152              :          * buffer.
    6153              :          */
    6154           29 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = EndOfLog;
    6155              :     }
    6156              : 
    6157              :     /*
    6158              :      * Update local and shared status.  This is OK to do without any locks
    6159              :      * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
    6160              :      */
    6161          940 :     LogwrtResult.Write = LogwrtResult.Flush = EndOfLog;
    6162          940 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult, EndOfLog);
    6163          940 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, EndOfLog);
    6164          940 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, EndOfLog);
    6165          940 :     XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndOfLog;
    6166          940 :     XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = EndOfLog;
    6167              : 
    6168              :     /*
    6169              :      * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
    6170              :      */
    6171          940 :     PreallocXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6172              : 
    6173              :     /*
    6174              :      * Okay, we're officially UP.
    6175              :      */
    6176          940 :     InRecovery = false;
    6177              : 
    6178              :     /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
    6179          940 :     XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    6180          940 :     XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = EndOfLog;
    6181              : 
    6182              :     /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
    6183          940 :     LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6184          940 :     TransamVariables->latestCompletedXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
    6185          940 :     FullTransactionIdRetreat(&TransamVariables->latestCompletedXid);
    6186          940 :     LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock);
    6187              : 
    6188              :     /*
    6189              :      * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby.  (commit
    6190              :      * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
    6191              :      */
    6192          940 :     if (standbyState == STANDBY_DISABLED)
    6193          886 :         StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
    6194              : 
    6195              :     /*
    6196              :      * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
    6197              :      */
    6198          940 :     TrimCLOG();
    6199          940 :     TrimMultiXact();
    6200              : 
    6201              :     /*
    6202              :      * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions.  This needs to
    6203              :      * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
    6204              :      * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
    6205              :      */
    6206          940 :     RecoverPreparedTransactions();
    6207              : 
    6208              :     /* Shut down xlogreader */
    6209          940 :     ShutdownWalRecovery();
    6210              : 
    6211              :     /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
    6212          940 :     LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
    6213              : 
    6214              :     /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
    6215          940 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(abortedRecPtr))
    6216              :     {
    6217              :         Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(missingContrecPtr));
    6218           11 :         CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(abortedRecPtr, missingContrecPtr, newTLI);
    6219              :     }
    6220              : 
    6221              :     /*
    6222              :      * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
    6223              :      * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
    6224              :      * record is written.
    6225              :      */
    6226          940 :     Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
    6227          940 :     UpdateFullPageWrites();
    6228              : 
    6229              :     /*
    6230              :      * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
    6231              :      */
    6232          940 :     if (performedWalRecovery)
    6233          162 :         promoted = PerformRecoveryXLogAction();
    6234              : 
    6235              :     /*
    6236              :      * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
    6237              :      * backends to write WAL.
    6238              :      */
    6239          940 :     XLogReportParameters();
    6240              : 
    6241              :     /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
    6242          940 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
    6243           54 :         CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6244              : 
    6245              :     /*
    6246              :      * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
    6247              :      * commit timestamp.
    6248              :      */
    6249          940 :     CompleteCommitTsInitialization();
    6250              : 
    6251              :     /*
    6252              :      * Update logical decoding status in shared memory and write an
    6253              :      * XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE, if necessary.
    6254              :      */
    6255          940 :     UpdateLogicalDecodingStatusEndOfRecovery();
    6256              : 
    6257              :     /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
    6258          940 :     if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
    6259          922 :         pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
    6260          940 :     pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
    6261          940 :     pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo);
    6262              : 
    6263              :     /*
    6264              :      * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
    6265              :      *
    6266              :      * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
    6267              :      * consequence.  SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
    6268              :      * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
    6269              :      * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
    6270              :      * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
    6271              :      * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
    6272              :      * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
    6273              :      *
    6274              :      * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
    6275              :      * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
    6276              :      * updates to shared memory.
    6277              :      */
    6278          940 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6279          940 :     ControlFile->state = DB_IN_PRODUCTION;
    6280              : 
    6281          940 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6282          940 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_DONE;
    6283          940 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6284              : 
    6285          940 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6286          940 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6287              : 
    6288              :     /*
    6289              :      * Wake up the checkpointer process as there might be a request to disable
    6290              :      * logical decoding by concurrent slot drop.
    6291              :      */
    6292          940 :     WakeupCheckpointer();
    6293              : 
    6294              :     /*
    6295              :      * Wake up all waiters.  They need to report an error that recovery was
    6296              :      * ended before reaching the target LSN.
    6297              :      */
    6298          940 :     WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_REPLAY, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    6299          940 :     WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_WRITE, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    6300          940 :     WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_FLUSH, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    6301              : 
    6302              :     /*
    6303              :      * Shutdown the recovery environment.  This must occur after
    6304              :      * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
    6305              :      * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
    6306              :      * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
    6307              :      * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage.  This is
    6308              :      * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
    6309              :      * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
    6310              :      */
    6311          940 :     if (standbyState != STANDBY_DISABLED)
    6312           54 :         ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
    6313              : 
    6314              :     /*
    6315              :      * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
    6316              :      * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
    6317              :      */
    6318          940 :     WalSndWakeup(true, true);
    6319              : 
    6320              :     /*
    6321              :      * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
    6322              :      * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
    6323              :      * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
    6324              :      * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
    6325              :      */
    6326          940 :     if (promoted)
    6327           47 :         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE);
    6328          940 : }
    6329              : 
    6330              : /*
    6331              :  * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
    6332              :  * recovery to archive recovery mode.  Updates the control file accordingly.
    6333              :  */
    6334              : void
    6335            2 : SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
    6336              : {
    6337              :     /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
    6338            2 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6339            2 :     ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY;
    6340            2 :     if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
    6341              :     {
    6342            2 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
    6343            2 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
    6344              :     }
    6345              :     /* update local copy */
    6346            2 :     LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    6347            2 :     LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    6348              : 
    6349              :     /*
    6350              :      * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
    6351              :      * this point.
    6352              :      */
    6353            2 :     updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
    6354              : 
    6355            2 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6356              : 
    6357              :     /*
    6358              :      * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
    6359              :      * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
    6360              :      */
    6361            2 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6362            2 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
    6363            2 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6364              : 
    6365            2 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6366            2 : }
    6367              : 
    6368              : /*
    6369              :  * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
    6370              :  * Updates the control file accordingly.
    6371              :  */
    6372              : void
    6373           79 : ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
    6374              : {
    6375              :     /*
    6376              :      * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
    6377              :      * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
    6378              :      * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery).  Reset
    6379              :      * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
    6380              :      * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
    6381              :      * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
    6382              :      */
    6383           79 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6384              : 
    6385           79 :     if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
    6386              :     {
    6387           74 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
    6388           74 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = tli;
    6389              :     }
    6390              : 
    6391           79 :     ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6392           79 :     ControlFile->backupEndPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6393           79 :     ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false;
    6394           79 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6395              : 
    6396           79 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6397           79 : }
    6398              : 
    6399              : /*
    6400              :  * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
    6401              :  *
    6402              :  * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
    6403              :  * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
    6404              :  * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
    6405              :  * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
    6406              :  * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
    6407              :  * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
    6408              :  */
    6409              : static bool
    6410          162 : PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
    6411              : {
    6412          162 :     bool        promoted = false;
    6413              : 
    6414              :     /*
    6415              :      * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
    6416              :      *
    6417              :      * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
    6418              :      * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
    6419              :      * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
    6420              :      * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
    6421              :      * checking in xlog_redo.
    6422              :      *
    6423              :      * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
    6424              :      * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
    6425              :      * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
    6426              :      */
    6427          216 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && IsUnderPostmaster &&
    6428           54 :         PromoteIsTriggered())
    6429              :     {
    6430           47 :         promoted = true;
    6431              : 
    6432              :         /*
    6433              :          * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
    6434              :          * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
    6435              :          * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
    6436              :          * could continue to be for minutes after this.  That sounds strange,
    6437              :          * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
    6438              :          * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
    6439              :          * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
    6440              :          */
    6441           47 :         CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord();
    6442              :     }
    6443              :     else
    6444              :     {
    6445          115 :         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
    6446              :                           CHECKPOINT_FAST |
    6447              :                           CHECKPOINT_WAIT);
    6448              :     }
    6449              : 
    6450          162 :     return promoted;
    6451              : }
    6452              : 
    6453              : /*
    6454              :  * Is the system still in recovery?
    6455              :  *
    6456              :  * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
    6457              :  * shared memory.
    6458              :  */
    6459              : bool
    6460     82784197 : RecoveryInProgress(void)
    6461              : {
    6462              :     /*
    6463              :      * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
    6464              :      * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
    6465              :      * shared variable has once been seen false.
    6466              :      */
    6467     82784197 :     if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress)
    6468     80548909 :         return false;
    6469              :     else
    6470              :     {
    6471              :         /*
    6472              :          * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
    6473              :          * shared variable.
    6474              :          */
    6475      2235288 :         volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
    6476              : 
    6477      2235288 :         LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6478              : 
    6479              :         /*
    6480              :          * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
    6481              :          * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
    6482              :          * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
    6483              :          */
    6484              : 
    6485      2235288 :         return LocalRecoveryInProgress;
    6486              :     }
    6487              : }
    6488              : 
    6489              : /*
    6490              :  * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
    6491              :  *
    6492              :  * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
    6493              :  * file.  See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
    6494              :  */
    6495              : RecoveryState
    6496        16421 : GetRecoveryState(void)
    6497              : {
    6498              :     RecoveryState retval;
    6499              : 
    6500        16421 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6501        16421 :     retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
    6502        16421 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6503              : 
    6504        16421 :     return retval;
    6505              : }
    6506              : 
    6507              : /*
    6508              :  * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
    6509              :  *
    6510              :  * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
    6511              :  * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
    6512              :  * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
    6513              :  */
    6514              : bool
    6515     40963358 : XLogInsertAllowed(void)
    6516              : {
    6517              :     /*
    6518              :      * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
    6519              :      * return it.  This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
    6520              :      * done.
    6521              :      */
    6522     40963358 :     if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
    6523     40248238 :         return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
    6524              : 
    6525              :     /*
    6526              :      * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
    6527              :      */
    6528       715120 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    6529       705275 :         return false;
    6530              : 
    6531              :     /*
    6532              :      * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
    6533              :      * no need to keep checking.
    6534              :      */
    6535         9845 :     LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
    6536         9845 :     return true;
    6537              : }
    6538              : 
    6539              : /*
    6540              :  * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
    6541              :  *
    6542              :  * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
    6543              :  * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
    6544              :  *
    6545              :  * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
    6546              :  */
    6547              : static int
    6548          969 : LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
    6549              : {
    6550          969 :     int         oldXLogAllowed = LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
    6551              : 
    6552          969 :     LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
    6553              : 
    6554          969 :     return oldXLogAllowed;
    6555              : }
    6556              : 
    6557              : /*
    6558              :  * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
    6559              :  *
    6560              :  * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
    6561              :  */
    6562              : XLogRecPtr
    6563       303029 : GetRedoRecPtr(void)
    6564              : {
    6565              :     XLogRecPtr  ptr;
    6566              : 
    6567              :     /*
    6568              :      * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
    6569              :      * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
    6570              :      * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
    6571              :      * the lock.
    6572              :      */
    6573       303029 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6574       303029 :     ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
    6575       303029 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6576              : 
    6577       303029 :     if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
    6578         1606 :         RedoRecPtr = ptr;
    6579              : 
    6580       303029 :     return RedoRecPtr;
    6581              : }
    6582              : 
    6583              : /*
    6584              :  * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
    6585              :  * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
    6586              :  *
    6587              :  * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
    6588              :  * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
    6589              :  * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively.  XLogInsertRecord will
    6590              :  * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
    6591              :  */
    6592              : void
    6593     15549762 : GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
    6594              : {
    6595     15549762 :     *RedoRecPtr_p = RedoRecPtr;
    6596     15549762 :     *doPageWrites_p = doPageWrites;
    6597     15549762 : }
    6598              : 
    6599              : /*
    6600              :  * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
    6601              :  *
    6602              :  * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
    6603              :  * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
    6604              :  * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
    6605              :  * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
    6606              :  */
    6607              : XLogRecPtr
    6608         7054 : GetInsertRecPtr(void)
    6609              : {
    6610              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6611              : 
    6612         7054 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6613         7054 :     recptr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
    6614         7054 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6615              : 
    6616         7054 :     return recptr;
    6617              : }
    6618              : 
    6619              : /*
    6620              :  * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
    6621              :  * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
    6622              :  * system that is known not to be in recovery.
    6623              :  */
    6624              : XLogRecPtr
    6625       178966 : GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
    6626              : {
    6627              :     Assert(XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState == RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6628              : 
    6629       178966 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    6630              : 
    6631              :     /*
    6632              :      * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
    6633              :      * no lock is required.
    6634              :      */
    6635       178966 :     if (insertTLI)
    6636        25977 :         *insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6637              : 
    6638       178966 :     return LogwrtResult.Flush;
    6639              : }
    6640              : 
    6641              : /*
    6642              :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
    6643              :  * is not in recovery.
    6644              :  */
    6645              : TimeLineID
    6646       108378 : GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
    6647              : {
    6648              :     Assert(XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState == RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6649              : 
    6650              :     /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
    6651       108378 :     return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6652              : }
    6653              : 
    6654              : /*
    6655              :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet -- If the system is not in recovery, returns
    6656              :  * the WAL insertion timeline; else, returns 0. Wherever possible, use
    6657              :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLine() instead, since it's cheaper. Note that this
    6658              :  * function decides recovery has ended as soon as the insert TLI is set, which
    6659              :  * happens before we set XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.
    6660              :  */
    6661              : TimeLineID
    6662            1 : GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet(void)
    6663              : {
    6664              :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
    6665              : 
    6666            1 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6667            1 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6668            1 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6669              : 
    6670            1 :     return insertTLI;
    6671              : }
    6672              : 
    6673              : /*
    6674              :  * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
    6675              :  * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
    6676              :  * important.
    6677              :  *
    6678              :  * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
    6679              :  * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
    6680              :  */
    6681              : XLogRecPtr
    6682         1646 : GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
    6683              : {
    6684         1646 :     XLogRecPtr  res = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6685              :     int         i;
    6686              : 
    6687        14814 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    6688              :     {
    6689              :         XLogRecPtr  last_important;
    6690              : 
    6691              :         /*
    6692              :          * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
    6693              :          * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
    6694              :          * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
    6695              :          */
    6696        13168 :         LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6697        13168 :         last_important = WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt;
    6698        13168 :         LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
    6699              : 
    6700        13168 :         if (res < last_important)
    6701         2873 :             res = last_important;
    6702              :     }
    6703              : 
    6704         1646 :     return res;
    6705              : }
    6706              : 
    6707              : /*
    6708              :  * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
    6709              :  */
    6710              : pg_time_t
    6711            0 : GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
    6712              : {
    6713              :     pg_time_t   result;
    6714              : 
    6715              :     /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
    6716            0 :     LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_SHARED);
    6717            0 :     result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
    6718            0 :     *lastSwitchLSN = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN;
    6719            0 :     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    6720              : 
    6721            0 :     return result;
    6722              : }
    6723              : 
    6724              : /*
    6725              :  * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
    6726              :  */
    6727              : void
    6728          695 : ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
    6729              : {
    6730              :     /*
    6731              :      * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
    6732              :      * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
    6733              :      */
    6734              :     Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
    6735              :     Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
    6736              :            CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
    6737          695 :     CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
    6738              : 
    6739              :     /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
    6740          695 :     ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
    6741              :             (errmsg("shutting down")));
    6742              : 
    6743              :     /*
    6744              :      * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
    6745              :      */
    6746          695 :     WalSndInitStopping();
    6747              : 
    6748              :     /*
    6749              :      * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state.  This prevents commands
    6750              :      * from writing new WAL.
    6751              :      */
    6752          695 :     WalSndWaitStopping();
    6753              : 
    6754          695 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    6755           58 :         CreateRestartPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_FAST);
    6756              :     else
    6757              :     {
    6758              :         /*
    6759              :          * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
    6760              :          * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
    6761              :          * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
    6762              :          * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
    6763              :          */
    6764          637 :         if (XLogArchivingActive())
    6765           16 :             RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    6766              : 
    6767          637 :         CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_FAST);
    6768              :     }
    6769          695 : }
    6770              : 
    6771              : /*
    6772              :  * Format checkpoint request flags as a space-separated string for
    6773              :  * log messages.
    6774              :  */
    6775              : static const char *
    6776         2996 : CheckpointFlagsString(int flags)
    6777              : {
    6778              :     static char buf[128];
    6779              : 
    6780        23968 :     snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
    6781         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
    6782         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
    6783         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
    6784         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
    6785         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
    6786         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
    6787         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
    6788         2996 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "");
    6789              : 
    6790         2996 :     return buf;
    6791              : }
    6792              : 
    6793              : /*
    6794              :  * Log start of a checkpoint.
    6795              :  */
    6796              : static void
    6797         1498 : LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
    6798              : {
    6799         1498 :     if (restartpoint)
    6800          199 :         ereport(LOG,
    6801              :         /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
    6802              :                 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s",
    6803              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
    6804              :     else
    6805         1299 :         ereport(LOG,
    6806              :         /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
    6807              :                 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s",
    6808              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
    6809         1498 : }
    6810              : 
    6811              : /*
    6812              :  * Log end of a checkpoint.
    6813              :  */
    6814              : static void
    6815         1796 : LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint, int flags)
    6816              : {
    6817              :     long        write_msecs,
    6818              :                 sync_msecs,
    6819              :                 total_msecs,
    6820              :                 longest_msecs,
    6821              :                 average_msecs;
    6822              :     uint64      average_sync_time;
    6823              : 
    6824         1796 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    6825              : 
    6826         1796 :     write_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t,
    6827              :                                                   CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t);
    6828              : 
    6829         1796 :     sync_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t,
    6830              :                                                  CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t);
    6831              : 
    6832              :     /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
    6833         1796 :     PendingCheckpointerStats.write_time += write_msecs;
    6834         1796 :     PendingCheckpointerStats.sync_time += sync_msecs;
    6835              : 
    6836              :     /*
    6837              :      * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for.  Only
    6838              :      * continue if a log message is to be written.
    6839              :      */
    6840         1796 :     if (!log_checkpoints)
    6841          298 :         return;
    6842              : 
    6843         1498 :     total_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t,
    6844              :                                                   CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t);
    6845              : 
    6846              :     /*
    6847              :      * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
    6848              :      * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
    6849              :      */
    6850         1498 :     longest_msecs = (long) ((CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync + 999) / 1000);
    6851              : 
    6852         1498 :     average_sync_time = 0;
    6853         1498 :     if (CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels > 0)
    6854            0 :         average_sync_time = CheckpointStats.ckpt_agg_sync_time /
    6855            0 :             CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels;
    6856         1498 :     average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
    6857              : 
    6858              :     /*
    6859              :      * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
    6860              :      * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
    6861              :      * this moment.
    6862              :      */
    6863         1498 :     if (restartpoint)
    6864          199 :         ereport(LOG,
    6865              :                 (errmsg("restartpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
    6866              :                         "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
    6867              :                         "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
    6868              :                         "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
    6869              :                         "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
    6870              :                         "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
    6871              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
    6872              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    6873              :                         (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
    6874              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_slru_written,
    6875              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    6876              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    6877              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
    6878              :                         write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
    6879              :                         sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
    6880              :                         total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
    6881              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
    6882              :                         longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
    6883              :                         average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
    6884              :                         (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
    6885              :                         (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
    6886              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint),
    6887              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo))));
    6888              :     else
    6889         1299 :         ereport(LOG,
    6890              :                 (errmsg("checkpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
    6891              :                         "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
    6892              :                         "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
    6893              :                         "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
    6894              :                         "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
    6895              :                         "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
    6896              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
    6897              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    6898              :                         (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
    6899              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_slru_written,
    6900              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    6901              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    6902              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
    6903              :                         write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
    6904              :                         sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
    6905              :                         total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
    6906              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
    6907              :                         longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
    6908              :                         average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
    6909              :                         (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
    6910              :                         (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
    6911              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint),
    6912              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo))));
    6913              : }
    6914              : 
    6915              : /*
    6916              :  * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
    6917              :  *
    6918              :  * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
    6919              :  * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
    6920              :  */
    6921              : static void
    6922         1796 : UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
    6923              : {
    6924              :     /*
    6925              :      * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
    6926              :      * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
    6927              :      * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
    6928              :      * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
    6929              :      * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
    6930              :      * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
    6931              :      * more.
    6932              :      *
    6933              :      * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
    6934              :      * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
    6935              :      *
    6936              :      * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
    6937              :      * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
    6938              :      * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
    6939              :      * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
    6940              :      * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
    6941              :      * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
    6942              :      * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
    6943              :      * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
    6944              :      * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
    6945              :      */
    6946         1796 :     PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
    6947         1796 :     if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
    6948          782 :         CheckPointDistanceEstimate = nbytes;
    6949              :     else
    6950         1014 :         CheckPointDistanceEstimate =
    6951         1014 :             (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
    6952         1796 : }
    6953              : 
    6954              : /*
    6955              :  * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint.  Note that
    6956              :  * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
    6957              :  * from a critical section.
    6958              :  */
    6959              : static void
    6960         3592 : update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
    6961              : {
    6962              :     /*
    6963              :      * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
    6964              :      * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints.  Updating the ps display is
    6965              :      * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
    6966              :      * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
    6967              :      * process.
    6968              :      */
    6969         3592 :     if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)) == 0)
    6970         2216 :         return;
    6971              : 
    6972         1376 :     if (reset)
    6973          688 :         set_ps_display("");
    6974              :     else
    6975              :     {
    6976              :         char        activitymsg[128];
    6977              : 
    6978         2064 :         snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
    6979          688 :                  (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
    6980          688 :                  (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
    6981              :                  restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
    6982          688 :         set_ps_display(activitymsg);
    6983              :     }
    6984              : }
    6985              : 
    6986              : 
    6987              : /*
    6988              :  * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
    6989              :  *
    6990              :  * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
    6991              :  *  CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
    6992              :  *  CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
    6993              :  *  CHECKPOINT_FAST: finish the checkpoint ASAP, ignoring
    6994              :  *      checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
    6995              :  *  CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
    6996              :  *      since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
    6997              :  *      CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
    6998              :  *  CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
    6999              :  *
    7000              :  * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
    7001              :  * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
    7002              :  * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
    7003              :  *
    7004              :  * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    7005              :  * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
    7006              :  * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
    7007              :  * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
    7008              :  * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
    7009              :  * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
    7010              :  * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
    7011              :  * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
    7012              :  * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
    7013              :  * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
    7014              :  *
    7015              :  * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
    7016              :  * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
    7017              :  * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
    7018              :  * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
    7019              :  * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
    7020              :  *
    7021              :  * Returns true if a new checkpoint was performed, or false if it was skipped
    7022              :  * because the system was idle.
    7023              :  */
    7024              : bool
    7025         1599 : CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
    7026              : {
    7027              :     bool        shutdown;
    7028              :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    7029              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7030              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    7031         1599 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    7032              :     uint32      freespace;
    7033              :     XLogRecPtr  PriorRedoPtr;
    7034              :     XLogRecPtr  last_important_lsn;
    7035              :     VirtualTransactionId *vxids;
    7036              :     int         nvxids;
    7037         1599 :     int         oldXLogAllowed = 0;
    7038              : 
    7039              :     /*
    7040              :      * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
    7041              :      * issued at a different time.
    7042              :      */
    7043         1599 :     if (flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY))
    7044          666 :         shutdown = true;
    7045              :     else
    7046          933 :         shutdown = false;
    7047              : 
    7048              :     /* sanity check */
    7049         1599 :     if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
    7050            0 :         elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
    7051              : 
    7052              :     /*
    7053              :      * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
    7054              :      *
    7055              :      * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
    7056              :      * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
    7057              :      * log_checkpoints is currently off.
    7058              :      */
    7059        17589 :     MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
    7060         1599 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7061              : 
    7062              :     /*
    7063              :      * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
    7064              :      * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer.  Note that
    7065              :      * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
    7066              :      * checkpoint is needed.
    7067              :      */
    7068         1599 :     SyncPreCheckpoint();
    7069              : 
    7070              :     /* Run these points outside the critical section. */
    7071         1599 :     INJECTION_POINT("create-checkpoint-initial", NULL);
    7072         1599 :     INJECTION_POINT_LOAD("create-checkpoint-run");
    7073              : 
    7074              :     /*
    7075              :      * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
    7076              :      */
    7077         1599 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7078              : 
    7079         1599 :     if (shutdown)
    7080              :     {
    7081          666 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7082          666 :         ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNING;
    7083          666 :         UpdateControlFile();
    7084          666 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7085              :     }
    7086              : 
    7087              :     /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
    7088        20787 :     MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
    7089         1599 :     checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    7090              : 
    7091              :     /*
    7092              :      * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
    7093              :      * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
    7094              :      * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
    7095              :      */
    7096         1599 :     if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    7097          905 :         checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
    7098              :     else
    7099          694 :         checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    7100              : 
    7101              :     /*
    7102              :      * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
    7103              :      * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
    7104              :      */
    7105         1599 :     last_important_lsn = GetLastImportantRecPtr();
    7106              : 
    7107              :     /*
    7108              :      * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
    7109              :      * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it.  The idea here is to
    7110              :      * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
    7111              :      */
    7112         1599 :     if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
    7113              :                   CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
    7114              :     {
    7115          196 :         if (last_important_lsn == ControlFile->checkPoint)
    7116              :         {
    7117            2 :             END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7118            2 :             ereport(DEBUG1,
    7119              :                     (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
    7120            2 :             return false;
    7121              :         }
    7122              :     }
    7123              : 
    7124              :     /*
    7125              :      * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
    7126              :      * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
    7127              :      * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
    7128              :      */
    7129         1597 :     if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7130           29 :         oldXLogAllowed = LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
    7131              : 
    7132         1597 :     checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7133         1597 :     if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7134           29 :         checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
    7135              :     else
    7136         1568 :         checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
    7137              : 
    7138              :     /*
    7139              :      * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
    7140              :      */
    7141         1597 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7142              : 
    7143         1597 :     checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
    7144         1597 :     checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
    7145              : 
    7146         1597 :     if (shutdown)
    7147              :     {
    7148          666 :         XLogRecPtr  curInsert = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(Insert->CurrBytePos);
    7149              : 
    7150              :         /*
    7151              :          * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
    7152              :          *
    7153              :          * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
    7154              :          * WAL insertion.
    7155              :          */
    7156          666 :         freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
    7157          666 :         if (freespace == 0)
    7158              :         {
    7159            0 :             if (XLogSegmentOffset(curInsert, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    7160            0 :                 curInsert += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    7161              :             else
    7162            0 :                 curInsert += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    7163              :         }
    7164          666 :         checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
    7165              : 
    7166              :         /*
    7167              :          * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
    7168              :          * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
    7169              :          *
    7170              :          * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
    7171              :          * left pointing past where it really needs to point.  This is okay;
    7172              :          * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
    7173              :          * that it didn't really need to.  We can't postpone advancing
    7174              :          * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
    7175              :          * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
    7176              :          * the checkpoint.
    7177              :          */
    7178          666 :         RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    7179              :     }
    7180              : 
    7181              :     /*
    7182              :      * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
    7183              :      * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
    7184              :      */
    7185         1597 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7186              : 
    7187              :     /*
    7188              :      * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
    7189              :      * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    7190              :      * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
    7191              :      * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
    7192              :      * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
    7193              :      * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
    7194              :      * mark the redo point.
    7195              :      */
    7196         1597 :     if (!shutdown)
    7197              :     {
    7198              :         /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
    7199          931 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    7200          931 :         XLogRegisterData(&wal_level, sizeof(wal_level));
    7201          931 :         (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO);
    7202              : 
    7203              :         /*
    7204              :          * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
    7205              :          * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
    7206              :          * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
    7207              :          * checkpoint is complete.
    7208              :          */
    7209          931 :         checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
    7210              :     }
    7211              : 
    7212              :     /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
    7213         1597 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7214         1597 :     XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    7215         1597 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7216              : 
    7217              :     /*
    7218              :      * If enabled, log checkpoint start.  We postpone this until now so as not
    7219              :      * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
    7220              :      */
    7221         1597 :     if (log_checkpoints)
    7222         1299 :         LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
    7223              : 
    7224         1597 :     INJECTION_POINT_CACHED("create-checkpoint-run", NULL);
    7225              : 
    7226              :     /* Update the process title */
    7227         1597 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
    7228              : 
    7229              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
    7230              : 
    7231              :     /*
    7232              :      * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
    7233              :      *
    7234              :      * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
    7235              :      * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
    7236              :      * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
    7237              :      * there.
    7238              :      */
    7239         1597 :     LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
    7240         1597 :     checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
    7241         1597 :     checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
    7242         1597 :     checkPoint.oldestXidDB = TransamVariables->oldestXidDB;
    7243         1597 :     LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    7244              : 
    7245         1597 :     LWLockAcquire(CommitTsLock, LW_SHARED);
    7246         1597 :     checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = TransamVariables->oldestCommitTsXid;
    7247         1597 :     checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = TransamVariables->newestCommitTsXid;
    7248         1597 :     LWLockRelease(CommitTsLock);
    7249              : 
    7250         1597 :     LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
    7251         1597 :     checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
    7252         1597 :     if (!shutdown)
    7253          931 :         checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
    7254         1597 :     LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    7255              : 
    7256         1597 :     checkPoint.logicalDecodingEnabled = IsLogicalDecodingEnabled();
    7257              : 
    7258         1597 :     MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(shutdown,
    7259              :                              &checkPoint.nextMulti,
    7260              :                              &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
    7261              :                              &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    7262              :                              &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    7263              : 
    7264              :     /*
    7265              :      * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
    7266              :      * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
    7267              :      *
    7268              :      * This I/O could fail for various reasons.  If so, we will fail to
    7269              :      * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
    7270              :      * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
    7271              :      */
    7272         1597 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7273              : 
    7274              :     /*
    7275              :      * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
    7276              :      * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
    7277              :      * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
    7278              :      * performing those groups of actions.
    7279              :      *
    7280              :      * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
    7281              :      * that are currently in commit critical sections.  If an xact inserted
    7282              :      * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
    7283              :      * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
    7284              :      * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact.  So
    7285              :      * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
    7286              :      * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
    7287              :      *
    7288              :      * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
    7289              :      * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
    7290              :      * to wait for.  But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
    7291              :      * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
    7292              :      * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
    7293              :      * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
    7294              :      * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
    7295              :      * minimizing lock contention.)
    7296              :      *
    7297              :      * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
    7298              :      * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
    7299              :      * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
    7300              :      * clog and we will correctly flush the update below.  So we cannot miss
    7301              :      * any xacts we need to wait for.
    7302              :      */
    7303         1597 :     vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids, DELAY_CHKPT_START);
    7304         1597 :     if (nvxids > 0)
    7305              :     {
    7306              :         do
    7307              :         {
    7308              :             /*
    7309              :              * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
    7310              :              * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
    7311              :              * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
    7312              :              */
    7313           54 :             AbsorbSyncRequests();
    7314              : 
    7315           54 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_START);
    7316           54 :             pg_usleep(10000L);  /* wait for 10 msec */
    7317           54 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    7318           54 :         } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
    7319              :                                               DELAY_CHKPT_START));
    7320              :     }
    7321         1597 :     pfree(vxids);
    7322              : 
    7323         1597 :     CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
    7324              : 
    7325         1597 :     vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids, DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE);
    7326         1597 :     if (nvxids > 0)
    7327              :     {
    7328              :         do
    7329              :         {
    7330            0 :             AbsorbSyncRequests();
    7331              : 
    7332            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_COMPLETE);
    7333            0 :             pg_usleep(10000L);  /* wait for 10 msec */
    7334            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    7335            0 :         } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
    7336              :                                               DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE));
    7337              :     }
    7338         1597 :     pfree(vxids);
    7339              : 
    7340              :     /*
    7341              :      * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
    7342              :      * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
    7343              :      * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
    7344              :      *
    7345              :      * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
    7346              :      * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
    7347              :      */
    7348         1597 :     if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    7349          903 :         LogStandbySnapshot();
    7350              : 
    7351         1597 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7352              : 
    7353              :     /*
    7354              :      * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
    7355              :      */
    7356         1597 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7357         1597 :     XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
    7358         1597 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID,
    7359              :                         shutdown ? XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN :
    7360              :                         XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE);
    7361              : 
    7362         1597 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7363              : 
    7364              :     /*
    7365              :      * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
    7366              :      * overwritten at next startup.  No-one should even try, this just allows
    7367              :      * sanity-checking.  In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
    7368              :      * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
    7369              :      * recovery.
    7370              :      */
    7371         1597 :     if (shutdown)
    7372              :     {
    7373          666 :         if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7374           29 :             LocalXLogInsertAllowed = oldXLogAllowed;
    7375              :         else
    7376          637 :             LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
    7377              :     }
    7378              : 
    7379              :     /*
    7380              :      * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
    7381              :      * = end of actual checkpoint record.
    7382              :      */
    7383         1597 :     if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
    7384            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    7385              :                 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
    7386              : 
    7387              :     /*
    7388              :      * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
    7389              :      * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
    7390              :      */
    7391         1597 :     PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    7392              : 
    7393              :     /*
    7394              :      * Update the control file.
    7395              :      */
    7396         1597 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7397         1597 :     if (shutdown)
    7398          666 :         ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
    7399         1597 :     ControlFile->checkPoint = ProcLastRecPtr;
    7400         1597 :     ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
    7401              :     /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
    7402         1597 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    7403         1597 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
    7404              : 
    7405              :     /*
    7406              :      * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
    7407              :      * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
    7408              :      * for debugging purposes.
    7409              :      */
    7410         1597 :     ControlFile->unloggedLSN = pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN);
    7411              : 
    7412         1597 :     UpdateControlFile();
    7413         1597 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7414              : 
    7415              :     /*
    7416              :      * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
    7417              :      * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
    7418              :      */
    7419         1597 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7420              : 
    7421              :     /*
    7422              :      * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
    7423              :      * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
    7424              :      * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
    7425              :      * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
    7426              :      * happen before it can be summarized.
    7427              :      *
    7428              :      * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
    7429              :      * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
    7430              :      * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
    7431              :      * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    7432              :      * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
    7433              :      * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
    7434              :      * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
    7435              :      * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
    7436              :      * record.
    7437              :      */
    7438         1597 :     WakeupWalSummarizer();
    7439              : 
    7440              :     /*
    7441              :      * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
    7442              :      */
    7443         1597 :     SyncPostCheckpoint();
    7444              : 
    7445              :     /*
    7446              :      * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
    7447              :      * exists.
    7448              :      */
    7449         1597 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(PriorRedoPtr))
    7450         1597 :         UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
    7451              : 
    7452         1597 :     INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
    7453              : 
    7454              :     /*
    7455              :      * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
    7456              :      * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
    7457              :      */
    7458         1597 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7459         1597 :     KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
    7460         1597 :     if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED | RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT,
    7461              :                                            _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
    7462              :                                            InvalidTransactionId))
    7463              :     {
    7464              :         /*
    7465              :          * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
    7466              :          * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
    7467              :          */
    7468            4 :         XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7469            4 :         KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
    7470              :     }
    7471         1597 :     _logSegNo--;
    7472         1597 :     RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, recptr,
    7473              :                        checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
    7474              : 
    7475              :     /*
    7476              :      * Make more log segments if needed.  (Do this after recycling old log
    7477              :      * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
    7478              :      */
    7479         1597 :     if (!shutdown)
    7480          931 :         PreallocXlogFiles(recptr, checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
    7481              : 
    7482              :     /*
    7483              :      * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible.  We can throw away all data before
    7484              :      * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction.  No future transaction will
    7485              :      * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
    7486              :      * in subtrans.c).  During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
    7487              :      * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
    7488              :      */
    7489         1597 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7490         1568 :         TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
    7491              : 
    7492              :     /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
    7493         1597 :     LogCheckpointEnd(false, flags);
    7494              : 
    7495              :     /* Reset the process title */
    7496         1597 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
    7497              : 
    7498              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_DONE(CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    7499              :                                      NBuffers,
    7500              :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    7501              :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    7502              :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled);
    7503              : 
    7504         1597 :     return true;
    7505              : }
    7506              : 
    7507              : /*
    7508              :  * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
    7509              :  * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
    7510              :  * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
    7511              :  *
    7512              :  * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
    7513              :  * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
    7514              :  */
    7515              : static void
    7516           47 : CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
    7517              : {
    7518              :     xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
    7519              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7520              : 
    7521              :     /* sanity check */
    7522           47 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7523            0 :         elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
    7524              : 
    7525           47 :     xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7526           47 :     xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
    7527              : 
    7528           47 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7529           47 :     xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7530           47 :     xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
    7531           47 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7532              : 
    7533           47 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7534              : 
    7535           47 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7536           47 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
    7537           47 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY);
    7538              : 
    7539           47 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7540              : 
    7541              :     /*
    7542              :      * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
    7543              :      * changes to this point.
    7544              :      */
    7545           47 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7546           47 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = recptr;
    7547           47 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
    7548           47 :     UpdateControlFile();
    7549           47 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7550              : 
    7551           47 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7552           47 : }
    7553              : 
    7554              : /*
    7555              :  * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
    7556              :  *
    7557              :  * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
    7558              :  * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
    7559              :  * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
    7560              :  * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
    7561              :  * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind".  So the first action after
    7562              :  * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
    7563              :  * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
    7564              :  * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
    7565              :  * to the page header where the record occurs.  xlogreader has an ad-hoc
    7566              :  * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
    7567              :  * use here.
    7568              :  *
    7569              :  * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
    7570              :  * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
    7571              :  * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
    7572              :  * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
    7573              :  *
    7574              :  * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
    7575              :  * It is included in the WAL record.  'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
    7576              :  * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted.  They must
    7577              :  * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
    7578              :  * can verify that.
    7579              :  */
    7580              : static XLogRecPtr
    7581           11 : CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr,
    7582              :                                 TimeLineID newTLI)
    7583              : {
    7584              :     xl_overwrite_contrecord xlrec;
    7585              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7586              :     XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
    7587              :     XLogRecPtr  startPos;
    7588              : 
    7589              :     /* sanity checks */
    7590           11 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7591            0 :         elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
    7592           11 :     if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
    7593            0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
    7594              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(pagePtr));
    7595              : 
    7596              :     /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
    7597           11 :     startPos = pagePtr;
    7598           11 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(startPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    7599            1 :         startPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    7600              :     else
    7601           10 :         startPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    7602           11 :     recptr = GetXLogInsertRecPtr();
    7603           11 :     if (recptr != startPos)
    7604            0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
    7605              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recptr));
    7606              : 
    7607           11 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7608              : 
    7609              :     /*
    7610              :      * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
    7611              :      * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
    7612              :      *
    7613              :      * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
    7614              :      * insertion lock is just pro forma.
    7615              :      */
    7616           11 :     WALInsertLockAcquire();
    7617           11 :     pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) GetXLogBuffer(pagePtr, newTLI);
    7618           11 :     pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD;
    7619           11 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7620              : 
    7621              :     /*
    7622              :      * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
    7623              :      * page.  We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
    7624              :      * allowed to write WAL yet.
    7625              :      */
    7626           11 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7627           11 :     xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
    7628           11 :     xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7629           11 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_overwrite_contrecord));
    7630           11 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD);
    7631              : 
    7632              :     /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
    7633           11 :     if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
    7634            0 :         elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
    7635              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ProcLastRecPtr));
    7636              : 
    7637           11 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7638              : 
    7639           11 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7640              : 
    7641           11 :     return recptr;
    7642              : }
    7643              : 
    7644              : /*
    7645              :  * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
    7646              :  *
    7647              :  * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
    7648              :  * recovery restartpoints.
    7649              :  */
    7650              : static void
    7651         1796 : CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
    7652              : {
    7653         1796 :     CheckPointRelationMap();
    7654         1796 :     CheckPointReplicationSlots(flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN);
    7655         1796 :     CheckPointSnapBuild();
    7656         1796 :     CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap();
    7657         1796 :     CheckPointReplicationOrigin();
    7658              : 
    7659              :     /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
    7660              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
    7661         1796 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7662         1796 :     CheckPointCLOG();
    7663         1796 :     CheckPointCommitTs();
    7664         1796 :     CheckPointSUBTRANS();
    7665         1796 :     CheckPointMultiXact();
    7666         1796 :     CheckPointPredicate();
    7667         1796 :     CheckPointBuffers(flags);
    7668              : 
    7669              :     /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
    7670              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_SYNC_START();
    7671         1796 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7672         1796 :     ProcessSyncRequests();
    7673         1796 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7674              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_DONE();
    7675              : 
    7676              :     /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
    7677         1796 :     CheckPointTwoPhase(checkPointRedo);
    7678         1796 : }
    7679              : 
    7680              : /*
    7681              :  * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
    7682              :  *
    7683              :  * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
    7684              :  * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
    7685              :  * not.  If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
    7686              :  * CreateRestartPoint can consult it.  (Note that the latter function is
    7687              :  * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
    7688              :  * startup process.)
    7689              :  */
    7690              : static void
    7691          728 : RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
    7692              : {
    7693              :     /*
    7694              :      * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
    7695              :      * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
    7696              :      * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
    7697              :      * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
    7698              :      * later.
    7699              :      */
    7700          728 :     if (XLogHaveInvalidPages())
    7701              :     {
    7702            0 :         elog(DEBUG2,
    7703              :              "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
    7704              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
    7705            0 :         return;
    7706              :     }
    7707              : 
    7708              :     /*
    7709              :      * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
    7710              :      * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
    7711              :      */
    7712          728 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7713          728 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr = record->ReadRecPtr;
    7714          728 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr = record->EndRecPtr;
    7715          728 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
    7716          728 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7717              : }
    7718              : 
    7719              : /*
    7720              :  * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
    7721              :  *
    7722              :  * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
    7723              :  * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
    7724              :  * replaying the entire recovery log.
    7725              :  *
    7726              :  * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
    7727              :  * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
    7728              :  * restartpoint.
    7729              :  */
    7730              : bool
    7731          585 : CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
    7732              : {
    7733              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7734              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7735              :     CheckPoint  lastCheckPoint;
    7736              :     XLogRecPtr  PriorRedoPtr;
    7737              :     XLogRecPtr  receivePtr;
    7738              :     XLogRecPtr  replayPtr;
    7739              :     TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    7740              :     XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    7741              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    7742              :     TimestampTz xtime;
    7743              : 
    7744              :     /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
    7745              :     Assert(!IsUnderPostmaster || MyBackendType == B_CHECKPOINTER);
    7746              : 
    7747              :     /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
    7748          585 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7749          585 :     lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7750          585 :     lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7751          585 :     lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
    7752          585 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7753              : 
    7754              :     /*
    7755              :      * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
    7756              :      * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
    7757              :      */
    7758          585 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7759              :     {
    7760            0 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    7761              :                 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
    7762            0 :         return false;
    7763              :     }
    7764              : 
    7765              :     /*
    7766              :      * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
    7767              :      * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
    7768              :      * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
    7769              :      * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
    7770              :      * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
    7771              :      * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
    7772              :      * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
    7773              :      * immediate shutdown, though.
    7774              :      *
    7775              :      * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
    7776              :      * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
    7777              :      * side-effect.
    7778              :      */
    7779          585 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
    7780          253 :         lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
    7781              :     {
    7782          386 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    7783              :                 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
    7784              :                                 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
    7785              : 
    7786          386 :         UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
    7787          386 :         if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
    7788              :         {
    7789           36 :             LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7790           36 :             ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
    7791           36 :             UpdateControlFile();
    7792           36 :             LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7793              :         }
    7794          386 :         return false;
    7795              :     }
    7796              : 
    7797              :     /*
    7798              :      * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
    7799              :      * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
    7800              :      * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
    7801              :      *
    7802              :      * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
    7803              :      * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
    7804              :      * happening.
    7805              :      */
    7806          199 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7807          199 :     RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
    7808          199 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7809              : 
    7810              :     /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
    7811          199 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7812          199 :     XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
    7813          199 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7814              : 
    7815              :     /*
    7816              :      * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
    7817              :      *
    7818              :      * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
    7819              :      * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
    7820              :      * log_checkpoints is currently off.
    7821              :      */
    7822         2189 :     MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
    7823          199 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7824              : 
    7825          199 :     if (log_checkpoints)
    7826          199 :         LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
    7827              : 
    7828              :     /* Update the process title */
    7829          199 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
    7830              : 
    7831          199 :     CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
    7832              : 
    7833              :     /*
    7834              :      * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
    7835              :      * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
    7836              :      */
    7837          199 :     INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
    7838              : 
    7839              :     /*
    7840              :      * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
    7841              :      * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
    7842              :      */
    7843          199 :     PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    7844              : 
    7845              :     /*
    7846              :      * Update pg_control, using current time.  Check that it still shows an
    7847              :      * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
    7848              :      * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
    7849              :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
    7850              :      */
    7851          199 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7852          199 :     if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
    7853              :     {
    7854              :         /*
    7855              :          * Update the checkpoint information.  We do this even if the cluster
    7856              :          * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
    7857              :          * segments recycled below.
    7858              :          */
    7859          199 :         ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7860          199 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
    7861              : 
    7862              :         /*
    7863              :          * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
    7864              :          * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY.  Normally,
    7865              :          * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
    7866              :          * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied.  We do
    7867              :          * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
    7868              :          * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
    7869              :          * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
    7870              :          * included, at a minimum.  Note that for an ordinary restart of
    7871              :          * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
    7872              :          * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
    7873              :          * checkpoint record.
    7874              :          */
    7875          199 :         if (ControlFile->state == DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY)
    7876              :         {
    7877          199 :             if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
    7878              :             {
    7879           19 :                 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7880           19 :                 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = lastCheckPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
    7881              : 
    7882              :                 /* update local copy */
    7883           19 :                 LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    7884           19 :                 LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    7885              :             }
    7886          199 :             if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
    7887           22 :                 ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
    7888              :         }
    7889          199 :         UpdateControlFile();
    7890              :     }
    7891          199 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7892              : 
    7893              :     /*
    7894              :      * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
    7895              :      * prior checkpoint exists.
    7896              :      */
    7897          199 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(PriorRedoPtr))
    7898          199 :         UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
    7899              : 
    7900              :     /*
    7901              :      * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
    7902              :      * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
    7903              :      */
    7904          199 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7905              : 
    7906              :     /*
    7907              :      * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
    7908              :      * whichever is later.
    7909              :      */
    7910          199 :     receivePtr = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(NULL, NULL);
    7911          199 :     replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    7912          199 :     endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
    7913          199 :     KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
    7914              : 
    7915          199 :     INJECTION_POINT("restartpoint-before-slot-invalidation", NULL);
    7916              : 
    7917          199 :     if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED | RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT,
    7918              :                                            _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
    7919              :                                            InvalidTransactionId))
    7920              :     {
    7921              :         /*
    7922              :          * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
    7923              :          * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
    7924              :          */
    7925            1 :         XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7926            1 :         KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
    7927              :     }
    7928          199 :     _logSegNo--;
    7929              : 
    7930              :     /*
    7931              :      * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
    7932              :      * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
    7933              :      * at end of recovery.  If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
    7934              :      * currently replaying.
    7935              :      *
    7936              :      * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
    7937              :      * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
    7938              :      * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
    7939              :      * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
    7940              :      * with that.
    7941              :      */
    7942          199 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7943            0 :         replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7944              : 
    7945          199 :     RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
    7946              : 
    7947              :     /*
    7948              :      * Make more log segments if needed.  (Do this after recycling old log
    7949              :      * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
    7950              :      */
    7951          199 :     PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
    7952              : 
    7953              :     /*
    7954              :      * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible.  We can throw away all data before
    7955              :      * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction.  No future transaction will
    7956              :      * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
    7957              :      * in subtrans.c).  When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
    7958              :      * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
    7959              :      */
    7960          199 :     if (EnableHotStandby)
    7961          199 :         TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
    7962              : 
    7963              :     /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
    7964          199 :     LogCheckpointEnd(true, flags);
    7965              : 
    7966              :     /* Reset the process title */
    7967          199 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
    7968              : 
    7969          199 :     xtime = GetLatestXTime();
    7970          199 :     ereport((log_checkpoints ? LOG : DEBUG2),
    7971              :             errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
    7972              :                    LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
    7973              :             xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
    7974              :                               timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0);
    7975              : 
    7976              :     /*
    7977              :      * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
    7978              :      */
    7979          199 :     if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0)
    7980            0 :         ExecuteRecoveryCommand(archiveCleanupCommand,
    7981              :                                "archive_cleanup_command",
    7982              :                                false,
    7983              :                                WAIT_EVENT_ARCHIVE_CLEANUP_COMMAND);
    7984              : 
    7985          199 :     return true;
    7986              : }
    7987              : 
    7988              : /*
    7989              :  * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
    7990              :  *      (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
    7991              :  *
    7992              :  * Returns one of the following enum values:
    7993              :  *
    7994              :  * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
    7995              :  *   max_wal_size.
    7996              :  *
    7997              :  * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
    7998              :  *   segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
    7999              :  *   than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
    8000              :  *
    8001              :  * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
    8002              :  *   remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
    8003              :  *   above.
    8004              :  *
    8005              :  * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
    8006              :  *   a slot with this LSN cannot continue.  (Any associated walsender
    8007              :  *   processes should have been terminated already.)
    8008              :  *
    8009              :  * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
    8010              :  */
    8011              : WALAvailability
    8012          660 : GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
    8013              : {
    8014              :     XLogRecPtr  currpos;        /* current write LSN */
    8015              :     XLogSegNo   currSeg;        /* segid of currpos */
    8016              :     XLogSegNo   targetSeg;      /* segid of targetLSN */
    8017              :     XLogSegNo   oldestSeg;      /* actual oldest segid */
    8018              :     XLogSegNo   oldestSegMaxWalSize;    /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
    8019              :     XLogSegNo   oldestSlotSeg;  /* oldest segid kept by slot */
    8020              :     uint64      keepSegs;
    8021              : 
    8022              :     /*
    8023              :      * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
    8024              :      */
    8025          660 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(targetLSN))
    8026           41 :         return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
    8027              : 
    8028              :     /*
    8029              :      * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
    8030              :      * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size.  Initialize
    8031              :      * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
    8032              :      */
    8033          619 :     currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
    8034          619 :     XLByteToSeg(currpos, oldestSlotSeg, wal_segment_size);
    8035          619 :     KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
    8036              : 
    8037              :     /*
    8038              :      * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
    8039              :      * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
    8040              :      * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
    8041              :      */
    8042          619 :     oldestSeg = XLogGetLastRemovedSegno() + 1;
    8043              : 
    8044              :     /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
    8045          619 :     XLByteToSeg(currpos, currSeg, wal_segment_size);
    8046          619 :     keepSegs = ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) + 1;
    8047              : 
    8048          619 :     if (currSeg > keepSegs)
    8049            8 :         oldestSegMaxWalSize = currSeg - keepSegs;
    8050              :     else
    8051          611 :         oldestSegMaxWalSize = 1;
    8052              : 
    8053              :     /* the segment we care about */
    8054          619 :     XLByteToSeg(targetLSN, targetSeg, wal_segment_size);
    8055              : 
    8056              :     /*
    8057              :      * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
    8058              :      * targetSeg is known to be lost.
    8059              :      */
    8060          619 :     if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
    8061              :     {
    8062              :         /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
    8063          618 :         if (targetSeg >= oldestSegMaxWalSize)
    8064          616 :             return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
    8065              : 
    8066              :         /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
    8067            2 :         return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
    8068              :     }
    8069              : 
    8070              :     /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
    8071            1 :     if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
    8072            1 :         return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
    8073              : 
    8074              :     /* Definitely lost */
    8075            0 :     return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
    8076              : }
    8077              : 
    8078              : 
    8079              : /*
    8080              :  * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
    8081              :  * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
    8082              :  *
    8083              :  * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
    8084              :  * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
    8085              :  * requirement of replication slots.  For the latter criterion we do consider
    8086              :  * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
    8087              :  * from recptr.
    8088              :  *
    8089              :  * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
    8090              :  * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
    8091              :  * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
    8092              :  * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
    8093              :  * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
    8094              :  */
    8095              : static void
    8096         2420 : KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
    8097              : {
    8098              :     XLogSegNo   currSegNo;
    8099              :     XLogSegNo   segno;
    8100              :     XLogRecPtr  keep;
    8101              : 
    8102         2420 :     XLByteToSeg(recptr, currSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    8103         2420 :     segno = currSegNo;
    8104              : 
    8105              :     /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
    8106         2420 :     keep = XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN();
    8107         2420 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(keep) && keep < recptr)
    8108              :     {
    8109          764 :         XLByteToSeg(keep, segno, wal_segment_size);
    8110              : 
    8111              :         /*
    8112              :          * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
    8113              :          * configured.  However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
    8114              :          * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
    8115              :          * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
    8116              :          */
    8117          764 :         if (max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb >= 0 && !IsBinaryUpgrade)
    8118              :         {
    8119              :             uint64      slot_keep_segs;
    8120              : 
    8121           23 :             slot_keep_segs =
    8122           23 :                 ConvertToXSegs(max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
    8123              : 
    8124           23 :             if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
    8125            6 :                 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
    8126              :         }
    8127              :     }
    8128              : 
    8129              :     /*
    8130              :      * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
    8131              :      * summarized.
    8132              :      */
    8133         2420 :     keep = GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(NULL, NULL);
    8134         2420 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(keep))
    8135              :     {
    8136              :         XLogSegNo   unsummarized_segno;
    8137              : 
    8138            7 :         XLByteToSeg(keep, unsummarized_segno, wal_segment_size);
    8139            7 :         if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
    8140            6 :             segno = unsummarized_segno;
    8141              :     }
    8142              : 
    8143              :     /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
    8144         2420 :     if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
    8145              :     {
    8146              :         uint64      keep_segs;
    8147              : 
    8148           74 :         keep_segs = ConvertToXSegs(wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
    8149           74 :         if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
    8150              :         {
    8151              :             /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
    8152           74 :             if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
    8153           70 :                 segno = 1;
    8154              :             else
    8155            4 :                 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
    8156              :         }
    8157              :     }
    8158              : 
    8159              :     /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
    8160         2420 :     if (segno < *logSegNo)
    8161          382 :         *logSegNo = segno;
    8162         2420 : }
    8163              : 
    8164              : /*
    8165              :  * Write a NEXTOID log record
    8166              :  */
    8167              : void
    8168          635 : XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
    8169              : {
    8170          635 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8171          635 :     XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
    8172          635 :     (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTOID);
    8173              : 
    8174              :     /*
    8175              :      * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
    8176              :      * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
    8177              :      * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
    8178              :      * record.  Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
    8179              :      * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
    8180              :      * does.
    8181              :      *
    8182              :      * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
    8183              :      * database.  When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
    8184              :      * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
    8185              :      * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does.  The impact
    8186              :      * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
    8187              :      * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
    8188              :      * with the leftover file or directory.  But since for safety's sake we
    8189              :      * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
    8190              :      * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
    8191              :      */
    8192          635 : }
    8193              : 
    8194              : /*
    8195              :  * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
    8196              :  *
    8197              :  * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
    8198              :  * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
    8199              :  *
    8200              :  * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
    8201              :  * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
    8202              :  * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
    8203              :  */
    8204              : XLogRecPtr
    8205          801 : RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
    8206              : {
    8207              :     XLogRecPtr  RecPtr;
    8208              : 
    8209              :     /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
    8210          801 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8211              : 
    8212          801 :     if (mark_unimportant)
    8213            0 :         XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT);
    8214          801 :     RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_SWITCH);
    8215              : 
    8216          801 :     return RecPtr;
    8217              : }
    8218              : 
    8219              : /*
    8220              :  * Write a RESTORE POINT record
    8221              :  */
    8222              : XLogRecPtr
    8223            3 : XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
    8224              : {
    8225              :     XLogRecPtr  RecPtr;
    8226              :     xl_restore_point xlrec;
    8227              : 
    8228            3 :     xlrec.rp_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    8229            3 :     strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
    8230              : 
    8231            3 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8232            3 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_restore_point));
    8233              : 
    8234            3 :     RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT);
    8235              : 
    8236            3 :     ereport(LOG,
    8237              :             errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
    8238              :                    rpName, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(RecPtr)));
    8239              : 
    8240            3 :     return RecPtr;
    8241              : }
    8242              : 
    8243              : /*
    8244              :  * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
    8245              :  * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
    8246              :  */
    8247              : static void
    8248          940 : XLogReportParameters(void)
    8249              : {
    8250          940 :     if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level ||
    8251          688 :         wal_log_hints != ControlFile->wal_log_hints ||
    8252          601 :         MaxConnections != ControlFile->MaxConnections ||
    8253          600 :         max_worker_processes != ControlFile->max_worker_processes ||
    8254          597 :         max_wal_senders != ControlFile->max_wal_senders ||
    8255          572 :         max_prepared_xacts != ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts ||
    8256          472 :         max_locks_per_xact != ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact ||
    8257          472 :         track_commit_timestamp != ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
    8258              :     {
    8259              :         /*
    8260              :          * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
    8261              :          * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
    8262              :          * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
    8263              :          * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
    8264              :          * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
    8265              :          */
    8266          480 :         if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level || XLogIsNeeded())
    8267              :         {
    8268              :             xl_parameter_change xlrec;
    8269              :             XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    8270              : 
    8271          455 :             xlrec.MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    8272          455 :             xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    8273          455 :             xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    8274          455 :             xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    8275          455 :             xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    8276          455 :             xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
    8277          455 :             xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    8278          455 :             xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    8279              : 
    8280          455 :             XLogBeginInsert();
    8281          455 :             XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
    8282              : 
    8283          455 :             recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE);
    8284          455 :             XLogFlush(recptr);
    8285              :         }
    8286              : 
    8287          480 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8288              : 
    8289          480 :         ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    8290          480 :         ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    8291          480 :         ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    8292          480 :         ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    8293          480 :         ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    8294          480 :         ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
    8295          480 :         ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    8296          480 :         ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    8297          480 :         UpdateControlFile();
    8298              : 
    8299          480 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8300              :     }
    8301          940 : }
    8302              : 
    8303              : /*
    8304              :  * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
    8305              :  * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
    8306              :  *
    8307              :  * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
    8308              :  * concurrently that could update it.
    8309              :  */
    8310              : void
    8311         1587 : UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
    8312              : {
    8313         1587 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    8314              :     bool        recoveryInProgress;
    8315              : 
    8316              :     /*
    8317              :      * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
    8318              :      *
    8319              :      * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
    8320              :      * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
    8321              :      * can update it.
    8322              :      */
    8323         1587 :     if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
    8324         1134 :         return;
    8325              : 
    8326              :     /*
    8327              :      * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
    8328              :      * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
    8329              :      * assertion failure.
    8330              :      */
    8331          453 :     recoveryInProgress = RecoveryInProgress();
    8332              : 
    8333          453 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    8334              : 
    8335              :     /*
    8336              :      * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
    8337              :      * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
    8338              :      * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
    8339              :      * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
    8340              :      * flag.
    8341              :      */
    8342          453 :     if (fullPageWrites)
    8343              :     {
    8344          442 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8345          442 :         Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
    8346          442 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    8347              :     }
    8348              : 
    8349              :     /*
    8350              :      * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
    8351              :      * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
    8352              :      */
    8353          453 :     if (XLogStandbyInfoActive() && !recoveryInProgress)
    8354              :     {
    8355            0 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    8356            0 :         XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
    8357              : 
    8358            0 :         XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE);
    8359              :     }
    8360              : 
    8361          453 :     if (!fullPageWrites)
    8362              :     {
    8363           11 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8364           11 :         Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
    8365           11 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    8366              :     }
    8367          453 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    8368              : }
    8369              : 
    8370              : /*
    8371              :  * XLOG resource manager's routines
    8372              :  *
    8373              :  * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
    8374              :  * not all record types are related to control file updates.
    8375              :  *
    8376              :  * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
    8377              :  * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
    8378              :  */
    8379              : void
    8380        44935 : xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
    8381              : {
    8382        44935 :     uint8       info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
    8383        44935 :     XLogRecPtr  lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
    8384              : 
    8385              :     /*
    8386              :      * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
    8387              :      * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
    8388              :      */
    8389              :     Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
    8390              :            !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
    8391              : 
    8392        44935 :     if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
    8393              :     {
    8394              :         Oid         nextOid;
    8395              : 
    8396              :         /*
    8397              :          * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
    8398              :          * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
    8399              :          * around.  Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
    8400              :          * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly.  We still take
    8401              :          * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
    8402              :          */
    8403           95 :         memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
    8404           95 :         LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8405           95 :         TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
    8406           95 :         TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    8407           95 :         LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    8408              :     }
    8409        44840 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
    8410              :     {
    8411              :         CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    8412              :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8413              : 
    8414           38 :         memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
    8415              :         /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
    8416           38 :         LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8417           38 :         TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8418           38 :         LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    8419           38 :         LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8420           38 :         TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    8421           38 :         TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    8422           38 :         LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    8423           38 :         MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
    8424              :                               checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    8425              : 
    8426           38 :         MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    8427              :                                checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    8428              : 
    8429              :         /*
    8430              :          * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
    8431              :          * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
    8432              :          */
    8433           38 :         SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    8434              : 
    8435              :         /*
    8436              :          * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
    8437              :          * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
    8438              :          * never arrive.
    8439              :          */
    8440           38 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
    8441           37 :             XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) &&
    8442            0 :             !XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint))
    8443            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8444              :                     (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
    8445              : 
    8446              :         /*
    8447              :          * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
    8448              :          * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
    8449              :          * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
    8450              :          * for prepared transactions.
    8451              :          */
    8452           38 :         if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED)
    8453              :         {
    8454              :             TransactionId *xids;
    8455              :             int         nxids;
    8456              :             TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
    8457              :             TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
    8458              :             RunningTransactionsData running;
    8459              : 
    8460           35 :             oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
    8461              : 
    8462              :             /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
    8463           35 :             StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
    8464              : 
    8465              :             /*
    8466              :              * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
    8467              :              * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
    8468              :              * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
    8469              :              * with their parent prepared transactions.
    8470              :              */
    8471           35 :             running.xcnt = nxids;
    8472           35 :             running.subxcnt = 0;
    8473           35 :             running.subxid_status = SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS;
    8474           35 :             running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    8475           35 :             running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
    8476           35 :             latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    8477           35 :             TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
    8478              :             Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
    8479           35 :             running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
    8480           35 :             running.xids = xids;
    8481              : 
    8482           35 :             ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
    8483              :         }
    8484              : 
    8485              :         /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
    8486           38 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8487           38 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8488           38 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8489              : 
    8490              :         /*
    8491              :          * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
    8492              :          * record.
    8493              :          */
    8494           38 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8495           38 :         if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8496            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8497              :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
    8498              :                             checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8499              : 
    8500           38 :         RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
    8501              : 
    8502              :         /*
    8503              :          * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
    8504              :          * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
    8505              :          * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
    8506              :          * AtEOXact_SMgr().
    8507              :          */
    8508           38 :         smgrdestroyall();
    8509              :     }
    8510        44802 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
    8511              :     {
    8512              :         CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    8513              :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8514              : 
    8515          690 :         memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
    8516              :         /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
    8517          690 :         LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8518          690 :         if (FullTransactionIdPrecedes(TransamVariables->nextXid,
    8519              :                                       checkPoint.nextXid))
    8520            0 :             TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8521          690 :         LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    8522              : 
    8523              :         /*
    8524              :          * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
    8525              :          * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records.  The nextOid
    8526              :          * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
    8527              :          * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records.  We could try to take the
    8528              :          * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
    8529              :          * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
    8530              :          * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do.  In any case,
    8531              :          * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
    8532              :          * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
    8533              :          */
    8534              : 
    8535              :         /* Handle multixact */
    8536          690 :         MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
    8537              :                                   checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    8538              : 
    8539              :         /*
    8540              :          * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
    8541              :          * generated by an older primary.
    8542              :          */
    8543          690 :         MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    8544              :                                checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    8545          690 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(TransamVariables->oldestXid,
    8546              :                                   checkPoint.oldestXid))
    8547            0 :             SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid,
    8548              :                                   checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    8549              :         /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
    8550          690 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8551          690 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8552          690 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8553              : 
    8554              :         /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
    8555          690 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8556          690 :         if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8557            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8558              :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
    8559              :                             checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8560              : 
    8561          690 :         RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
    8562              : 
    8563              :         /*
    8564              :          * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
    8565              :          * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
    8566              :          * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
    8567              :          * AtEOXact_SMgr().
    8568              :          */
    8569          690 :         smgrdestroyall();
    8570              :     }
    8571        44112 :     else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
    8572              :     {
    8573              :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
    8574              :     }
    8575        44111 :     else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    8576              :     {
    8577              :         xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
    8578              :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8579              : 
    8580           11 :         memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
    8581              : 
    8582              :         /*
    8583              :          * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
    8584              :          * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
    8585              :          * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
    8586              :          */
    8587              : 
    8588              :         /*
    8589              :          * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
    8590              :          * record.
    8591              :          */
    8592           11 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8593           11 :         if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8594            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8595              :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
    8596              :                             xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8597              :     }
    8598        44100 :     else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
    8599              :     {
    8600              :         /* nothing to do here */
    8601              :     }
    8602        44100 :     else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
    8603              :     {
    8604              :         /* nothing to do here */
    8605              :     }
    8606        43647 :     else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
    8607              :     {
    8608              :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
    8609              :     }
    8610        43642 :     else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
    8611              :     {
    8612              :         /*
    8613              :          * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
    8614              :          * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
    8615              :          * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
    8616              :          * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
    8617              :          *
    8618              :          * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
    8619              :          * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
    8620              :          * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
    8621              :          * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
    8622              :          * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
    8623              :          *
    8624              :          * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
    8625              :          * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
    8626              :          * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
    8627              :          */
    8628        90446 :         for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
    8629              :         {
    8630              :             Buffer      buffer;
    8631              : 
    8632        47645 :             if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
    8633              :             {
    8634           66 :                 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
    8635            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
    8636           66 :                 continue;
    8637              :             }
    8638              : 
    8639        47579 :             if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
    8640            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
    8641        47579 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    8642              :         }
    8643              :     }
    8644          841 :     else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
    8645              :     {
    8646              :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
    8647              :     }
    8648          747 :     else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
    8649              :     {
    8650              :         xl_parameter_change xlrec;
    8651              : 
    8652              :         /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
    8653           38 :         memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
    8654              : 
    8655           38 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8656           38 :         ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
    8657           38 :         ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
    8658           38 :         ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
    8659           38 :         ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
    8660           38 :         ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
    8661           38 :         ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
    8662           38 :         ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
    8663              : 
    8664              :         /*
    8665              :          * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
    8666              :          * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
    8667              :          * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
    8668              :          * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
    8669              :          * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
    8670              :          * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
    8671              :          */
    8672           38 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    8673              :         {
    8674           23 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    8675           23 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    8676              :         }
    8677           38 :         if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    8678              :         {
    8679              :             TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8680              : 
    8681           12 :             (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8682           12 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn;
    8683           12 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
    8684              :         }
    8685              : 
    8686           38 :         CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
    8687           38 :                                 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp);
    8688           38 :         ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
    8689              : 
    8690           38 :         UpdateControlFile();
    8691           38 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8692              : 
    8693              :         /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
    8694           38 :         CheckRequiredParameterValues();
    8695              :     }
    8696          709 :     else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
    8697              :     {
    8698              :         bool        fpw;
    8699              : 
    8700            0 :         memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
    8701              : 
    8702              :         /*
    8703              :          * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
    8704              :          * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
    8705              :          * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
    8706              :          */
    8707            0 :         if (!fpw)
    8708              :         {
    8709            0 :             SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8710            0 :             if (XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr < record->ReadRecPtr)
    8711            0 :                 XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr = record->ReadRecPtr;
    8712            0 :             SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8713              :         }
    8714              : 
    8715              :         /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
    8716            0 :         lastFullPageWrites = fpw;
    8717              :     }
    8718          709 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
    8719              :     {
    8720              :         /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
    8721              :     }
    8722           18 :     else if (info == XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE)
    8723              :     {
    8724              :         bool        status;
    8725              : 
    8726           18 :         memcpy(&status, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
    8727              : 
    8728              :         /*
    8729              :          * We need to toggle the logical decoding status and update the
    8730              :          * XLogLogicalInfo cache of processes synchronously because
    8731              :          * XLogLogicalInfoActive() is used even during read-only queries
    8732              :          * (e.g., via RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding()). In the
    8733              :          * 'disable' case, it is safe to invalidate existing slots after
    8734              :          * disabling logical decoding because logical decoding cannot process
    8735              :          * subsequent WAL records, which may not contain logical information.
    8736              :          */
    8737           18 :         if (status)
    8738            9 :             EnableLogicalDecoding();
    8739              :         else
    8740            9 :             DisableLogicalDecoding();
    8741              : 
    8742           18 :         elog(DEBUG1, "update logical decoding status to %d during recovery",
    8743              :              status);
    8744              : 
    8745           18 :         if (InRecovery && InHotStandby)
    8746              :         {
    8747           16 :             if (!status)
    8748              :             {
    8749              :                 /*
    8750              :                  * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the
    8751              :                  * primary disabled logical decoding.
    8752              :                  */
    8753            9 :                 InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL,
    8754              :                                                    0, InvalidOid,
    8755              :                                                    InvalidTransactionId);
    8756              :             }
    8757            7 :             else if (sync_replication_slots)
    8758              :             {
    8759              :                 /*
    8760              :                  * Signal the postmaster to launch the slotsync worker.
    8761              :                  *
    8762              :                  * XXX: For simplicity, we keep the slotsync worker running
    8763              :                  * even after logical decoding is disabled. A future
    8764              :                  * improvement can consider starting and stopping the worker
    8765              :                  * based on logical decoding status change.
    8766              :                  */
    8767            0 :                 kill(PostmasterPid, SIGUSR1);
    8768              :             }
    8769              :         }
    8770              :     }
    8771        44933 : }
    8772              : 
    8773              : /*
    8774              :  * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
    8775              :  * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and debug_io_direct.
    8776              :  */
    8777              : static int
    8778        16539 : get_sync_bit(int method)
    8779              : {
    8780        16539 :     int         o_direct_flag = 0;
    8781              : 
    8782              :     /*
    8783              :      * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process.  The WAL
    8784              :      * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
    8785              :      * after it's written.  Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
    8786              :      * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
    8787              :      */
    8788        16539 :     if ((io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) && !AmWalReceiverProcess())
    8789            9 :         o_direct_flag = PG_O_DIRECT;
    8790              : 
    8791              :     /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
    8792        16539 :     if (!enableFsync)
    8793        16539 :         return o_direct_flag;
    8794              : 
    8795            0 :     switch (method)
    8796              :     {
    8797              :             /*
    8798              :              * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
    8799              :              * not supported on the current platform.  But if not, they are
    8800              :              * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
    8801              :              * be seen here.
    8802              :              */
    8803            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
    8804              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
    8805              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
    8806            0 :             return o_direct_flag;
    8807              : #ifdef O_SYNC
    8808            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
    8809            0 :             return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
    8810              : #endif
    8811              : #ifdef O_DSYNC
    8812            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
    8813            0 :             return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
    8814              : #endif
    8815            0 :         default:
    8816              :             /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
    8817            0 :             elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
    8818              :             return 0;           /* silence warning */
    8819              :     }
    8820              : }
    8821              : 
    8822              : /*
    8823              :  * GUC support
    8824              :  */
    8825              : void
    8826         1188 : assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
    8827              : {
    8828         1188 :     if (wal_sync_method != new_wal_sync_method)
    8829              :     {
    8830              :         /*
    8831              :          * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
    8832              :          * currently open log segment (if any).  Also, if the open flag is
    8833              :          * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
    8834              :          * bit) at next use.
    8835              :          */
    8836            0 :         if (openLogFile >= 0)
    8837              :         {
    8838            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD_ASSIGN);
    8839            0 :             if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
    8840              :             {
    8841              :                 char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    8842              :                 int         save_errno;
    8843              : 
    8844            0 :                 save_errno = errno;
    8845            0 :                 XLogFileName(xlogfname, openLogTLI, openLogSegNo,
    8846              :                              wal_segment_size);
    8847            0 :                 errno = save_errno;
    8848            0 :                 ereport(PANIC,
    8849              :                         (errcode_for_file_access(),
    8850              :                          errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    8851              :             }
    8852              : 
    8853            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    8854            0 :             if (get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method) != get_sync_bit(new_wal_sync_method))
    8855            0 :                 XLogFileClose();
    8856              :         }
    8857              :     }
    8858         1188 : }
    8859              : 
    8860              : 
    8861              : /*
    8862              :  * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
    8863              :  *
    8864              :  * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
    8865              :  * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
    8866              :  */
    8867              : void
    8868       170542 : issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    8869              : {
    8870       170542 :     char       *msg = NULL;
    8871              :     instr_time  start;
    8872              : 
    8873              :     Assert(tli != 0);
    8874              : 
    8875              :     /*
    8876              :      * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
    8877              :      * file.
    8878              :      */
    8879       170542 :     if (!enableFsync ||
    8880            0 :         wal_sync_method == WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN ||
    8881            0 :         wal_sync_method == WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
    8882       170542 :         return;
    8883              : 
    8884              :     /*
    8885              :      * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
    8886              :      */
    8887            0 :     start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    8888              : 
    8889            0 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC);
    8890            0 :     switch (wal_sync_method)
    8891              :     {
    8892            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
    8893            0 :             if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
    8894            0 :                 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
    8895            0 :             break;
    8896              : #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
    8897              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
    8898              :             if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
    8899              :                 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
    8900              :             break;
    8901              : #endif
    8902            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
    8903            0 :             if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
    8904            0 :                 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
    8905            0 :             break;
    8906            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
    8907              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
    8908              :             /* not reachable */
    8909              :             Assert(false);
    8910            0 :             break;
    8911            0 :         default:
    8912            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8913              :                     errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    8914              :                     errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
    8915              :             break;
    8916              :     }
    8917              : 
    8918              :     /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
    8919            0 :     if (msg)
    8920              :     {
    8921              :         char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    8922            0 :         int         save_errno = errno;
    8923              : 
    8924            0 :         XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    8925            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    8926            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    8927              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    8928              :                  errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
    8929              :     }
    8930              : 
    8931            0 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    8932              : 
    8933            0 :     pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_NORMAL, IOOP_FSYNC,
    8934              :                             start, 1, 0);
    8935              : }
    8936              : 
    8937              : /*
    8938              :  * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
    8939              :  * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
    8940              :  * backup state and tablespace map.
    8941              :  *
    8942              :  * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
    8943              :  * the checkpoint in fast mode), and "tablespaces" (if non-NULL, indicates a
    8944              :  * list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the cluster's tablespaces.).
    8945              :  *
    8946              :  * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
    8947              :  * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
    8948              :  * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
    8949              :  * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
    8950              :  * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
    8951              :  * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
    8952              :  *
    8953              :  * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
    8954              :  * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
    8955              :  * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
    8956              :  *
    8957              :  * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
    8958              :  * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
    8959              :  * backups active at the same time.
    8960              :  *
    8961              :  * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
    8962              :  * permissions of the calling user!
    8963              :  */
    8964              : void
    8965          171 : do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
    8966              :                    BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
    8967              : {
    8968              :     bool        backup_started_in_recovery;
    8969              : 
    8970              :     Assert(state != NULL);
    8971          171 :     backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
    8972              : 
    8973              :     /*
    8974              :      * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
    8975              :      * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
    8976              :      */
    8977          171 :     if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
    8978            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8979              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    8980              :                  errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
    8981              :                  errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
    8982              : 
    8983          171 :     if (strlen(backupidstr) > MAXPGPATH)
    8984            1 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8985              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    8986              :                  errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
    8987              :                         MAXPGPATH)));
    8988              : 
    8989          170 :     strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
    8990              : 
    8991              :     /*
    8992              :      * Mark backup active in shared memory.  We must do full-page WAL writes
    8993              :      * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
    8994              :      * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
    8995              :      * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
    8996              :      * our write to the same page.  This can be fixed as long as the first
    8997              :      * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
    8998              :      * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
    8999              :      * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
    9000              :      * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record.  (Once the
    9001              :      * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
    9002              :      * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
    9003              :      * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
    9004              :      *
    9005              :      * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
    9006              :      * backup from the standby.
    9007              :      *
    9008              :      * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
    9009              :      * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
    9010              :      * XLogInsertRecord().
    9011              :      */
    9012          170 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9013          170 :     XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups++;
    9014          170 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    9015              : 
    9016              :     /*
    9017              :      * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
    9018              :      * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
    9019              :      * after this block is over.
    9020              :      */
    9021          170 :     PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(do_pg_abort_backup, BoolGetDatum(true));
    9022              :     {
    9023          170 :         bool        gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
    9024              :         DIR        *tblspcdir;
    9025              :         struct dirent *de;
    9026              :         tablespaceinfo *ti;
    9027              :         int         datadirpathlen;
    9028              : 
    9029              :         /*
    9030              :          * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
    9031              :          * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
    9032              :          * old timeline IDs.  That would otherwise happen if you called
    9033              :          * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
    9034              :          * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
    9035              :          * the beginning with the old timeline ID.  That can cause trouble at
    9036              :          * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
    9037              :          * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
    9038              :          * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
    9039              :          *
    9040              :          * This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has
    9041              :          * XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record.
    9042              :          * Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to
    9043              :          * compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that
    9044              :          * occur after this point.
    9045              :          *
    9046              :          * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
    9047              :          * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
    9048              :          * recovery case described above.
    9049              :          */
    9050          170 :         if (!backup_started_in_recovery)
    9051          162 :             RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    9052              : 
    9053              :         do
    9054              :         {
    9055              :             bool        checkpointfpw;
    9056              : 
    9057              :             /*
    9058              :              * Force a CHECKPOINT.  Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
    9059              :              * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
    9060              :              * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
    9061              :              * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
    9062              :              *
    9063              :              * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
    9064              :              * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
    9065              :              * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
    9066              :              * positions.
    9067              :              *
    9068              :              * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
    9069              :              * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
    9070              :              * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
    9071              :              *
    9072              :              * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
    9073              :              * fast = true).  Otherwise this can take awhile.
    9074              :              */
    9075          170 :             RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE | CHECKPOINT_WAIT |
    9076              :                               (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
    9077              : 
    9078              :             /*
    9079              :              * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
    9080              :              * its REDO pointer.  The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
    9081              :              * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
    9082              :              * pointer.
    9083              :              */
    9084          170 :             LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9085          170 :             state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
    9086          170 :             state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    9087          170 :             state->starttli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
    9088          170 :             checkpointfpw = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.fullPageWrites;
    9089          170 :             LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9090              : 
    9091          170 :             if (backup_started_in_recovery)
    9092              :             {
    9093              :                 XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    9094              : 
    9095              :                 /*
    9096              :                  * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
    9097              :                  * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
    9098              :                  * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
    9099              :                  */
    9100            8 :                 SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9101            8 :                 recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
    9102            8 :                 SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9103              : 
    9104            8 :                 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
    9105            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    9106              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9107              :                              errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
    9108              :                                     "since last restartpoint"),
    9109              :                              errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
    9110              :                                      "is corrupt and should not be used. "
    9111              :                                      "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
    9112              :                                      "and then try an online backup again.")));
    9113              : 
    9114              :                 /*
    9115              :                  * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
    9116              :                  * record and don't write the backup history file, the
    9117              :                  * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
    9118              :                  * that two base backups started at the same time might use
    9119              :                  * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
    9120              :                  */
    9121            8 :                 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
    9122              :             }
    9123              : 
    9124              :             /*
    9125              :              * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
    9126              :              * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
    9127              :              * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
    9128              :              * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
    9129              :              * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
    9130              :              * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
    9131              :              * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
    9132              :              * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
    9133              :              * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
    9134              :              */
    9135          170 :             WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9136          170 :             if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
    9137              :             {
    9138          170 :                 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
    9139          170 :                 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
    9140              :             }
    9141          170 :             WALInsertLockRelease();
    9142          170 :         } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
    9143              : 
    9144              :         /*
    9145              :          * Construct tablespace_map file.
    9146              :          */
    9147          170 :         datadirpathlen = strlen(DataDir);
    9148              : 
    9149              :         /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
    9150          170 :         tblspcdir = AllocateDir(PG_TBLSPC_DIR);
    9151          547 :         while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
    9152              :         {
    9153              :             char        fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
    9154              :             char        linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
    9155          377 :             char       *relpath = NULL;
    9156              :             char       *s;
    9157              :             PGFileType  de_type;
    9158              :             char       *badp;
    9159              :             Oid         tsoid;
    9160              : 
    9161              :             /*
    9162              :              * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
    9163              :              *
    9164              :              * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
    9165              :              * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
    9166              :              * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
    9167              :              * criteria, skip it.
    9168              :              */
    9169          377 :             if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
    9170          340 :                 continue;
    9171           37 :             errno = 0;
    9172           37 :             tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
    9173           37 :             if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
    9174            0 :                 continue;
    9175              : 
    9176           37 :             snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
    9177              : 
    9178           37 :             de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
    9179              : 
    9180           37 :             if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
    9181              :             {
    9182              :                 StringInfoData escapedpath;
    9183              :                 int         rllen;
    9184              : 
    9185           23 :                 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
    9186           23 :                 if (rllen < 0)
    9187              :                 {
    9188            0 :                     ereport(WARNING,
    9189              :                             (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
    9190              :                                     fullpath)));
    9191            0 :                     continue;
    9192              :                 }
    9193           23 :                 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
    9194              :                 {
    9195            0 :                     ereport(WARNING,
    9196              :                             (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
    9197              :                                     fullpath)));
    9198            0 :                     continue;
    9199              :                 }
    9200           23 :                 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
    9201              : 
    9202              :                 /*
    9203              :                  * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
    9204              :                  * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
    9205              :                  * elsewhere.
    9206              :                  */
    9207           23 :                 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
    9208            1 :                     strncmp(linkpath, DataDir, datadirpathlen) == 0 &&
    9209            0 :                     IS_DIR_SEP(linkpath[datadirpathlen]))
    9210            0 :                     relpath = pstrdup(linkpath + datadirpathlen + 1);
    9211              : 
    9212              :                 /*
    9213              :                  * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
    9214              :                  * tablespace map file.
    9215              :                  */
    9216           23 :                 initStringInfo(&escapedpath);
    9217          562 :                 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
    9218              :                 {
    9219          539 :                     if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
    9220            0 :                         appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, '\\');
    9221          539 :                     appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, *s);
    9222              :                 }
    9223           23 :                 appendStringInfo(tblspcmapfile, "%s %s\n",
    9224           23 :                                  de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
    9225           23 :                 pfree(escapedpath.data);
    9226              :             }
    9227           14 :             else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
    9228              :             {
    9229              :                 /*
    9230              :                  * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
    9231              :                  * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
    9232              :                  * only.
    9233              :                  *
    9234              :                  * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
    9235              :                  * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
    9236              :                  */
    9237           14 :                 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
    9238           14 :                          PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
    9239           14 :                 relpath = pstrdup(linkpath);
    9240              :             }
    9241              :             else
    9242              :             {
    9243              :                 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
    9244            0 :                 continue;
    9245              :             }
    9246              : 
    9247           37 :             ti = palloc_object(tablespaceinfo);
    9248           37 :             ti->oid = tsoid;
    9249           37 :             ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
    9250           37 :             ti->rpath = relpath;
    9251           37 :             ti->size = -1;
    9252              : 
    9253           37 :             if (tablespaces)
    9254           37 :                 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
    9255              :         }
    9256          170 :         FreeDir(tblspcdir);
    9257              : 
    9258          170 :         state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    9259              :     }
    9260          170 :     PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(do_pg_abort_backup, BoolGetDatum(true));
    9261              : 
    9262          170 :     state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
    9263              : 
    9264              :     /*
    9265              :      * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
    9266              :      */
    9267          170 :     sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING;
    9268          170 : }
    9269              : 
    9270              : /*
    9271              :  * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
    9272              :  */
    9273              : SessionBackupState
    9274          191 : get_backup_status(void)
    9275              : {
    9276          191 :     return sessionBackupState;
    9277              : }
    9278              : 
    9279              : /*
    9280              :  * do_pg_backup_stop
    9281              :  *
    9282              :  * Utility function called at the end of an online backup.  It creates history
    9283              :  * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on.  It can optionally
    9284              :  * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
    9285              :  *
    9286              :  * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
    9287              :  * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
    9288              :  *
    9289              :  * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
    9290              :  * permissions of the calling user!
    9291              :  */
    9292              : void
    9293          164 : do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
    9294              : {
    9295          164 :     bool        backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
    9296              :     char        histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
    9297              :     char        lastxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    9298              :     char        histfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    9299              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    9300              :     FILE       *fp;
    9301              :     int         seconds_before_warning;
    9302          164 :     int         waits = 0;
    9303          164 :     bool        reported_waiting = false;
    9304              : 
    9305              :     Assert(state != NULL);
    9306              : 
    9307          164 :     backup_stopped_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
    9308              : 
    9309              :     /*
    9310              :      * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
    9311              :      * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
    9312              :      */
    9313          164 :     if (!backup_stopped_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
    9314            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    9315              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9316              :                  errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
    9317              :                  errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
    9318              : 
    9319              :     /*
    9320              :      * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
    9321              :      *
    9322              :      * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
    9323              :      * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
    9324              :      * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
    9325              :      */
    9326          164 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9327              : 
    9328              :     /*
    9329              :      * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
    9330              :      * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
    9331              :      */
    9332              :     Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups > 0);
    9333          164 :     XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups--;
    9334              : 
    9335              :     /*
    9336              :      * Clean up session-level lock.
    9337              :      *
    9338              :      * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
    9339              :      * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
    9340              :      * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
    9341              :      * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
    9342              :      * cleaned up before it.
    9343              :      */
    9344          164 :     sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
    9345              : 
    9346          164 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    9347              : 
    9348              :     /*
    9349              :      * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
    9350              :      * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
    9351              :      */
    9352          164 :     if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
    9353            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    9354              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9355              :                  errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
    9356              :                  errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
    9357              :                          "and should not be used. "
    9358              :                          "Try taking another online backup.")));
    9359              : 
    9360              :     /*
    9361              :      * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
    9362              :      * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
    9363              :      * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
    9364              :      * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
    9365              :      * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
    9366              :      * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
    9367              :      * however.
    9368              :      *
    9369              :      * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
    9370              :      * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
    9371              :      * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
    9372              :      * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
    9373              :      * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
    9374              :      * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
    9375              :      * available.
    9376              :      *
    9377              :      * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
    9378              :      * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
    9379              :      * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
    9380              :      * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
    9381              :      *
    9382              :      * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
    9383              :      * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
    9384              :      * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
    9385              :      * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
    9386              :      * backup history file during recovery.
    9387              :      */
    9388          164 :     if (backup_stopped_in_recovery)
    9389              :     {
    9390              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    9391              : 
    9392              :         /*
    9393              :          * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
    9394              :          * full-page writes.
    9395              :          */
    9396            8 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9397            8 :         recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
    9398            8 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9399              : 
    9400            8 :         if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
    9401            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9402              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9403              :                      errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
    9404              :                             "during online backup"),
    9405              :                      errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
    9406              :                              "is corrupt and should not be used. "
    9407              :                              "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
    9408              :                              "and then try an online backup again.")));
    9409              : 
    9410              : 
    9411            8 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9412            8 :         state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    9413            8 :         state->stoptli = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    9414            8 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9415              :     }
    9416              :     else
    9417              :     {
    9418              :         char       *history_file;
    9419              : 
    9420              :         /*
    9421              :          * Write the backup-end xlog record
    9422              :          */
    9423          156 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    9424          156 :         XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
    9425              :                          sizeof(state->startpoint));
    9426          156 :         state->stoppoint = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_BACKUP_END);
    9427              : 
    9428              :         /*
    9429              :          * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
    9430              :          * change, so we can read it without a lock.
    9431              :          */
    9432          156 :         state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    9433              : 
    9434              :         /*
    9435              :          * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
    9436              :          * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
    9437              :          */
    9438          156 :         RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    9439              : 
    9440          156 :         state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    9441              : 
    9442              :         /*
    9443              :          * Write the backup history file
    9444              :          */
    9445          156 :         XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9446          156 :         BackupHistoryFilePath(histfilepath, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9447              :                               state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
    9448          156 :         fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
    9449          156 :         if (!fp)
    9450            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9451              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    9452              :                      errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
    9453              :                             histfilepath)));
    9454              : 
    9455              :         /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
    9456          156 :         history_file = build_backup_content(state, true);
    9457          156 :         fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
    9458          156 :         pfree(history_file);
    9459              : 
    9460          156 :         if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
    9461            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9462              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    9463              :                      errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
    9464              :                             histfilepath)));
    9465              : 
    9466              :         /*
    9467              :          * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files.  As a side effect,
    9468              :          * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
    9469              :          * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
    9470              :          * immediately.
    9471              :          */
    9472          156 :         CleanupBackupHistory();
    9473              :     }
    9474              : 
    9475              :     /*
    9476              :      * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
    9477              :      * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
    9478              :      * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
    9479              :      * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
    9480              :      * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
    9481              :      * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
    9482              :      * the required WAL.
    9483              :      *
    9484              :      * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
    9485              :      * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
    9486              :      * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
    9487              :      * archived as well.
    9488              :      *
    9489              :      * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
    9490              :      * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
    9491              :      * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
    9492              :      * or you can set statement_timeout.  Also, some notices are issued to
    9493              :      * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
    9494              :      */
    9495              : 
    9496          164 :     if (waitforarchive &&
    9497           10 :         ((!backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingActive()) ||
    9498            1 :          (backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingAlways())))
    9499              :     {
    9500            4 :         XLByteToPrevSeg(state->stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9501            4 :         XLogFileName(lastxlogfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9502              :                      wal_segment_size);
    9503              : 
    9504            4 :         XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9505            4 :         BackupHistoryFileName(histfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9506              :                               state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
    9507              : 
    9508            4 :         seconds_before_warning = 60;
    9509            4 :         waits = 0;
    9510              : 
    9511           12 :         while (XLogArchiveIsBusy(lastxlogfilename) ||
    9512            4 :                XLogArchiveIsBusy(histfilename))
    9513              :         {
    9514            4 :             CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
    9515              : 
    9516            4 :             if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
    9517              :             {
    9518            0 :                 ereport(NOTICE,
    9519              :                         (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
    9520            0 :                 reported_waiting = true;
    9521              :             }
    9522              : 
    9523            4 :             (void) WaitLatch(MyLatch,
    9524              :                              WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH,
    9525              :                              1000L,
    9526              :                              WAIT_EVENT_BACKUP_WAIT_WAL_ARCHIVE);
    9527            4 :             ResetLatch(MyLatch);
    9528              : 
    9529            4 :             if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning)
    9530              :             {
    9531            0 :                 seconds_before_warning *= 2;    /* This wraps in >10 years... */
    9532            0 :                 ereport(WARNING,
    9533              :                         (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
    9534              :                                 waits),
    9535              :                          errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly.  "
    9536              :                                  "You can safely cancel this backup, "
    9537              :                                  "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
    9538              :             }
    9539              :         }
    9540              : 
    9541            4 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    9542              :                 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
    9543              :     }
    9544          160 :     else if (waitforarchive)
    9545            6 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    9546              :                 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
    9547          164 : }
    9548              : 
    9549              : 
    9550              : /*
    9551              :  * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
    9552              :  *
    9553              :  * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
    9554              :  * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
    9555              :  * an error handler.
    9556              :  *
    9557              :  * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
    9558              :  * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
    9559              :  * already been incremented.  When it's false, then it's invoked as a
    9560              :  * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
    9561              :  * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
    9562              :  *
    9563              :  * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
    9564              :  * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
    9565              :  */
    9566              : void
    9567            8 : do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
    9568              : {
    9569            8 :     bool        during_backup_start = DatumGetBool(arg);
    9570              : 
    9571              :     /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
    9572              :     Assert(!during_backup_start || sessionBackupState == SESSION_BACKUP_NONE);
    9573              : 
    9574            8 :     if (during_backup_start || sessionBackupState != SESSION_BACKUP_NONE)
    9575              :     {
    9576            6 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9577              :         Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups > 0);
    9578            6 :         XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups--;
    9579              : 
    9580            6 :         sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
    9581            6 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    9582              : 
    9583            6 :         if (!during_backup_start)
    9584            6 :             ereport(WARNING,
    9585              :                     errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
    9586              :     }
    9587            8 : }
    9588              : 
    9589              : /*
    9590              :  * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
    9591              :  * session, unless this has already been done.
    9592              :  */
    9593              : void
    9594            4 : register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
    9595              : {
    9596              :     static bool already_done = false;
    9597              : 
    9598            4 :     if (already_done)
    9599            1 :         return;
    9600            3 :     before_shmem_exit(do_pg_abort_backup, BoolGetDatum(false));
    9601            3 :     already_done = true;
    9602              : }
    9603              : 
    9604              : /*
    9605              :  * Get latest WAL insert pointer
    9606              :  */
    9607              : XLogRecPtr
    9608         2024 : GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
    9609              : {
    9610         2024 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    9611              :     uint64      current_bytepos;
    9612              : 
    9613         2024 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9614         2024 :     current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    9615         2024 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9616              : 
    9617         2024 :     return XLogBytePosToRecPtr(current_bytepos);
    9618              : }
    9619              : 
    9620              : /*
    9621              :  * Get latest WAL write pointer
    9622              :  */
    9623              : XLogRecPtr
    9624        13033 : GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
    9625              : {
    9626        13033 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    9627              : 
    9628        13033 :     return LogwrtResult.Write;
    9629              : }
    9630              : 
    9631              : /*
    9632              :  * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
    9633              :  * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
    9634              :  */
    9635              : void
    9636          390 : GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
    9637              : {
    9638          390 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9639          390 :     *oldrecptr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    9640          390 :     *oldtli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
    9641          390 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9642          390 : }
    9643              : 
    9644              : /* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
    9645              : void
    9646         1000 : XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
    9647              : {
    9648              :     Assert(AmStartupProcess() || !IsUnderPostmaster);
    9649              : 
    9650         1000 :     ShutdownWalRcv();
    9651         1000 :     ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    9652         1000 : }
    9653              : 
    9654              : /* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
    9655              : void
    9656         1182 : SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9657              : {
    9658         1182 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    9659         1182 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = true;
    9660         1182 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9661         1182 : }
    9662              : 
    9663              : /* Disable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
    9664              : void
    9665         1141 : ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9666              : {
    9667         1141 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    9668         1141 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = false;
    9669         1141 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9670         1141 : }
    9671              : 
    9672              : bool
    9673            0 : IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9674              : {
    9675              :     bool        result;
    9676              : 
    9677            0 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9678            0 :     result = XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive;
    9679            0 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9680              : 
    9681            0 :     return result;
    9682              : }
    9683              : 
    9684              : /*
    9685              :  * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
    9686              :  */
    9687              : void
    9688          538 : SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
    9689              : {
    9690          538 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9691          538 :     XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = sleeping;
    9692          538 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9693          538 : }
        

Generated by: LCOV version 2.0-1